OSDN Git Service

MacGui: Remove a bunch of verbose activity log messages for Point to Point encoding.
[handbrake-jp/handbrake-jp-git.git] / macosx / Controller.m
1 /* $Id: Controller.mm,v 1.79 2005/11/04 19:41:32 titer Exp $
2
3    This file is part of the HandBrake source code.
4    Homepage: <http://handbrake.fr/>.
5    It may be used under the terms of the GNU General Public License. */
6
7 #import "Controller.h"
8 #import "HBOutputPanelController.h"
9 #import "HBPreferencesController.h"
10 #import "HBDVDDetector.h"
11 #import "HBPresets.h"
12 #import "HBPreviewController.h"
13
14 #define DragDropSimplePboardType        @"MyCustomOutlineViewPboardType"
15
16 /* We setup the toolbar values here ShowPreviewIdentifier */
17 static NSString *        ToggleDrawerIdentifier             = @"Toggle Drawer Item Identifier";
18 static NSString *        StartEncodingIdentifier            = @"Start Encoding Item Identifier";
19 static NSString *        PauseEncodingIdentifier            = @"Pause Encoding Item Identifier";
20 static NSString *        ShowQueueIdentifier                = @"Show Queue Item Identifier";
21 static NSString *        AddToQueueIdentifier               = @"Add to Queue Item Identifier";
22 static NSString *        ShowPictureIdentifier             = @"Show Picture Window Item Identifier";
23 static NSString *        ShowPreviewIdentifier             = @"Show Preview Window Item Identifier";
24 static NSString *        ShowActivityIdentifier             = @"Debug Output Item Identifier";
25 static NSString *        ChooseSourceIdentifier             = @"Choose Source Item Identifier";
26
27
28 /*******************************
29  * HBController implementation *
30  *******************************/
31 @implementation HBController
32
33 - (id)init
34 {
35     self = [super init];
36     if( !self )
37     {
38         return nil;
39     }
40
41     /* replace bundled app icon with one which is 32/64-bit savvy */
42 #if defined( __LP64__ )
43     fApplicationIcon = [[NSImage alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:[[NSBundle mainBundle] pathForImageResource:@"HandBrake-64.icns"]];
44 #else
45     fApplicationIcon = [[NSImage alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:[[NSBundle mainBundle] pathForImageResource:@"HandBrake.icns"]];
46 #endif
47     if( fApplicationIcon != nil )
48         [NSApp setApplicationIconImage:fApplicationIcon];
49     
50     [HBPreferencesController registerUserDefaults];
51     fHandle = NULL;
52     fQueueEncodeLibhb = NULL;
53     /* Check for check for the app support directory here as
54      * outputPanel needs it right away, as may other future methods
55      */
56     NSString *libraryDir = [NSSearchPathForDirectoriesInDomains( NSLibraryDirectory,
57                                                                 NSUserDomainMask,
58                                                                 YES ) objectAtIndex:0];
59     AppSupportDirectory = [[libraryDir stringByAppendingPathComponent:@"Application Support"]
60                            stringByAppendingPathComponent:@"HandBrake"];
61     if( ![[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:AppSupportDirectory] )
62     {
63         [[NSFileManager defaultManager] createDirectoryAtPath:AppSupportDirectory
64                                                    attributes:nil];
65     }
66     /* Check for and create the App Support Preview directory if necessary */
67     NSString *PreviewDirectory = [AppSupportDirectory stringByAppendingPathComponent:@"Previews"];
68     if( ![[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:PreviewDirectory] )
69     {
70         [[NSFileManager defaultManager] createDirectoryAtPath:PreviewDirectory
71                                                    attributes:nil];
72     }                                                            
73     outputPanel = [[HBOutputPanelController alloc] init];
74     fPictureController = [[PictureController alloc] init];
75     fQueueController = [[HBQueueController alloc] init];
76     fAdvancedOptions = [[HBAdvancedController alloc] init];
77     /* we init the HBPresets class which currently is only used
78      * for updating built in presets, may move more functionality
79      * there in the future
80      */
81     fPresetsBuiltin = [[HBPresets alloc] init];
82     fPreferencesController = [[HBPreferencesController alloc] init];
83     /* Lets report the HandBrake version number here to the activity log and text log file */
84     NSString *versionStringFull = [[NSString stringWithFormat: @"Handbrake Version: %@", [[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleShortVersionString"]] stringByAppendingString: [NSString stringWithFormat: @" (%@)", [[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleVersion"]]];
85     [self writeToActivityLog: "%s", [versionStringFull UTF8String]];    
86     
87     return self;
88 }
89
90
91 - (void) applicationDidFinishLaunching: (NSNotification *) notification
92 {
93     /* Init libhb with check for updates libhb style set to "0" so its ignored and lets sparkle take care of it */
94     int loggingLevel = [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey:@"LoggingLevel"] intValue];
95     fHandle = hb_init(loggingLevel, 0);
96     /* Optional dvd nav UseDvdNav*/
97     hb_dvd_set_dvdnav([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey:@"UseDvdNav"] boolValue]);
98     /* Init a separate instance of libhb for user scanning and setting up jobs */
99     fQueueEncodeLibhb = hb_init(loggingLevel, 0);
100     
101         // Set the Growl Delegate
102     [GrowlApplicationBridge setGrowlDelegate: self];
103     /* Init others controllers */
104     [fPictureController SetHandle: fHandle];
105     [fPictureController   setHBController: self];
106     
107     [fQueueController   setHandle: fQueueEncodeLibhb];
108     [fQueueController   setHBController: self];
109
110     fChapterTitlesDelegate = [[ChapterTitles alloc] init];
111     [fChapterTable setDataSource:fChapterTitlesDelegate];
112     [fChapterTable setDelegate:fChapterTitlesDelegate];
113     
114     /* setup the subtitles delegate and connections to table */
115     fSubtitlesDelegate = [[HBSubtitles alloc] init];
116     [fSubtitlesTable setDataSource:fSubtitlesDelegate];
117     [fSubtitlesTable setDelegate:fSubtitlesDelegate];
118     [fSubtitlesTable setRowHeight:25.0];
119     
120     [fPresetsOutlineView setAutosaveName:@"Presets View"];
121     [fPresetsOutlineView setAutosaveExpandedItems:YES];
122     
123     dockIconProgress = 0;
124
125     /* Call UpdateUI every 1/2 sec */
126     [[NSRunLoop currentRunLoop] addTimer:[NSTimer
127                                           scheduledTimerWithTimeInterval:0.5 target:self
128                                           selector:@selector(updateUI:) userInfo:nil repeats:YES]
129                                  forMode:NSDefaultRunLoopMode];
130
131     // Open debug output window now if it was visible when HB was closed
132     if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"OutputPanelIsOpen"])
133         [self showDebugOutputPanel:nil];
134
135     // Open queue window now if it was visible when HB was closed
136     if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"QueueWindowIsOpen"])
137         [self showQueueWindow:nil];
138
139         [self openMainWindow:nil];
140     
141     /* We have to set the bool to tell hb what to do after a scan
142      * Initially we set it to NO until we start processing the queue
143      */
144      applyQueueToScan = NO;
145     
146     /* Now we re-check the queue array to see if there are
147      * any remaining encodes to be done in it and ask the
148      * user if they want to reload the queue */
149     if ([QueueFileArray count] > 0)
150         {
151         /* run  getQueueStats to see whats in the queue file */
152         [self getQueueStats];
153         /* this results in these values
154          * fEncodingQueueItem = 0;
155          * fPendingCount = 0;
156          * fCompletedCount = 0;
157          * fCanceledCount = 0;
158          * fWorkingCount = 0;
159          */
160         
161         /*On Screen Notification*/
162         NSString * alertTitle;
163         
164         /* We check to see if there is already another instance of hb running.
165          * Note: hbInstances == 1 means we are the only instance of HandBrake.app
166          */
167         if ([self hbInstances] > 1)
168         {
169         alertTitle = [NSString stringWithFormat:
170                          NSLocalizedString(@"There is already an instance of HandBrake running.", @"")];
171         NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet(
172                                       alertTitle,
173                                       NSLocalizedString(@"Reload Queue", nil),
174                                       nil,
175                                       nil,
176                                       fWindow, self,
177                                       nil, @selector(didDimissReloadQueue:returnCode:contextInfo:), nil,
178                                       NSLocalizedString(@" HandBrake will now load up the existing queue.", nil));    
179         }
180         else
181         {
182             if (fWorkingCount > 0)
183             {
184                 alertTitle = [NSString stringWithFormat:
185                               NSLocalizedString(@"HandBrake Has Detected %d Previously Encoding Item and %d Pending Item(s) In Your Queue.", @""),
186                               fWorkingCount,fPendingCount];
187             }
188             else
189             {
190                 alertTitle = [NSString stringWithFormat:
191                               NSLocalizedString(@"HandBrake Has Detected %d Pending Item(s) In Your Queue.", @""),
192                               fPendingCount];
193             }
194             
195             NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet(
196                                       alertTitle,
197                                       NSLocalizedString(@"Reload Queue", nil),
198                                       nil,
199                                       NSLocalizedString(@"Empty Queue", nil),
200                                       fWindow, self,
201                                       nil, @selector(didDimissReloadQueue:returnCode:contextInfo:), nil,
202                                       NSLocalizedString(@" Do you want to reload them ?", nil));
203         }
204         
205     }
206     else
207     {
208         /* We show whichever open source window specified in LaunchSourceBehavior preference key */
209         if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LaunchSourceBehavior"] isEqualToString: @"Open Source"])
210         {
211             [self browseSources:nil];
212         }
213         
214         if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LaunchSourceBehavior"] isEqualToString: @"Open Source (Title Specific)"])
215         {
216             [self browseSources:(id)fOpenSourceTitleMMenu];
217         }
218     }
219 }
220
221 - (int) hbInstances
222 {
223     /* check to see if another instance of HandBrake.app is running */
224     NSArray *runningAppDictionaries = [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] launchedApplications];
225     NSDictionary *aDictionary;
226     int hbInstances = 0;
227     for (aDictionary in runningAppDictionaries)
228         {
229         if ([[aDictionary valueForKey:@"NSApplicationName"] isEqualToString:@"HandBrake"])
230                 {
231             hbInstances++;
232                 }
233         }
234     return hbInstances;
235 }
236
237 - (void) didDimissReloadQueue: (NSWindow *)sheet returnCode: (int)returnCode contextInfo: (void *)contextInfo
238 {
239     if (returnCode == NSAlertOtherReturn)
240     {
241         [self clearQueueAllItems];
242         /* We show whichever open source window specified in LaunchSourceBehavior preference key */
243         if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LaunchSourceBehavior"] isEqualToString: @"Open Source"])
244         {
245             [self browseSources:nil];
246         }
247         
248         if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LaunchSourceBehavior"] isEqualToString: @"Open Source (Title Specific)"])
249         {
250             [self browseSources:(id)fOpenSourceTitleMMenu];
251         }
252     }
253     else
254     {
255         if ([self hbInstances] == 1)
256         {
257             [self setQueueEncodingItemsAsPending];
258         }
259         [self showQueueWindow:NULL];
260     }
261 }
262
263 - (NSApplicationTerminateReply) applicationShouldTerminate: (NSApplication *) app
264 {
265
266     
267     hb_state_t s;
268     hb_get_state( fQueueEncodeLibhb, &s );
269     
270     if ( s.state != HB_STATE_IDLE )
271     {
272         int result = NSRunCriticalAlertPanel(
273                                              NSLocalizedString(@"Are you sure you want to quit HandBrake?", nil),
274                                              NSLocalizedString(@"If you quit HandBrake your current encode will be reloaded into your queue at next launch. Do you want to quit anyway?", nil),
275                                              NSLocalizedString(@"Quit", nil), NSLocalizedString(@"Don't Quit", nil), nil, @"A movie" );
276         
277         if (result == NSAlertDefaultReturn)
278         {
279             return NSTerminateNow;
280         }
281         else
282             return NSTerminateCancel;
283     }
284     
285     // Warn if items still in the queue
286     else if ( fPendingCount > 0 )
287     {
288         int result = NSRunCriticalAlertPanel(
289                                              NSLocalizedString(@"Are you sure you want to quit HandBrake?", nil),
290                                              NSLocalizedString(@"There are pending encodes in your queue. Do you want to quit anyway?",nil),
291                                              NSLocalizedString(@"Quit", nil), NSLocalizedString(@"Don't Quit", nil), nil);
292         
293         if ( result == NSAlertDefaultReturn )
294             return NSTerminateNow;
295         else
296             return NSTerminateCancel;
297     }
298     
299     return NSTerminateNow;
300 }
301
302 - (void)applicationWillTerminate:(NSNotification *)aNotification
303 {
304     
305     [browsedSourceDisplayName release];
306     [outputPanel release];
307         [fQueueController release];
308     [fPreviewController release];
309     [fPictureController release];
310     [fApplicationIcon release];
311
312     hb_close(&fHandle);
313     hb_close(&fQueueEncodeLibhb);
314     hb_global_close();
315
316 }
317
318
319 - (void) awakeFromNib
320 {
321     [fWindow center];
322     [fWindow setExcludedFromWindowsMenu:NO];
323     
324     [fAdvancedOptions setView:fAdvancedView];
325     
326     /* lets setup our presets drawer for drag and drop here */
327     [fPresetsOutlineView registerForDraggedTypes: [NSArray arrayWithObject:DragDropSimplePboardType] ];
328     [fPresetsOutlineView setDraggingSourceOperationMask:NSDragOperationEvery forLocal:YES];
329     [fPresetsOutlineView setVerticalMotionCanBeginDrag: YES];
330     
331     /* Initialize currentScanCount so HB can use it to
332      evaluate successive scans */
333         currentScanCount = 0;
334     
335     
336     /* Init UserPresets .plist */
337         [self loadPresets];
338     
339     /* Init QueueFile .plist */
340     [self loadQueueFile];
341         
342     fRipIndicatorShown = NO;  // initially out of view in the nib
343     
344     /* For 64 bit builds, the threaded animation in the progress
345      * indicators conflicts with the animation in the advanced tab
346      * for reasons not completely clear. jbrjake found a note in the
347      * 10.5 dev notes regarding this possiblility. It was also noted
348      * that unless specified, setUsesThreadedAnimation defaults to true.
349      * So, at least for now we set the indicator animation to NO for
350      * both the scan and regular progress indicators for both 32 and 64 bit
351      * as it test out fine on both and there is no reason our progress indicators
352      * should require their own thread.
353      */
354
355     [fScanIndicator setUsesThreadedAnimation:NO];
356     [fRipIndicator setUsesThreadedAnimation:NO];
357   
358     
359     
360         /* Show/Dont Show Presets drawer upon launch based
361      on user preference DefaultPresetsDrawerShow*/
362         if( [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"DefaultPresetsDrawerShow"] > 0 )
363         {
364         [fPresetDrawer setDelegate:self];
365         NSSize drawerSize = NSSizeFromString( [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] 
366                                                stringForKey:@"Drawer Size"] );
367         if( drawerSize.width )
368             [fPresetDrawer setContentSize: drawerSize];
369                 [fPresetDrawer open];
370         }
371     
372     /* Initially set the dvd angle widgets to hidden (dvdnav only) */
373     [fSrcAngleLabel setHidden:YES];
374     [fSrcAnglePopUp setHidden:YES];
375     
376     /* Setup the start / stop popup */
377     [fEncodeStartStopPopUp removeAllItems];
378     [fEncodeStartStopPopUp addItemWithTitle: @"Chapters"];
379     [fEncodeStartStopPopUp addItemWithTitle: @"Seconds"];
380     [fEncodeStartStopPopUp addItemWithTitle: @"Frames"];
381     /* Align the start / stop widgets with the chapter popups */
382     [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField setFrameOrigin:[fSrcChapterStartPopUp frame].origin];
383     [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField setFrameOrigin:[fSrcChapterEndPopUp frame].origin];
384     
385     [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField setFrameOrigin:[fSrcChapterStartPopUp frame].origin];
386     [fSrcFrameEndEncodingField setFrameOrigin:[fSrcChapterEndPopUp frame].origin];
387     
388     /* Destination box*/
389     NSMenuItem *menuItem;
390     [fDstFormatPopUp removeAllItems];
391     // MP4 file
392     menuItem = [[fDstFormatPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"MP4 file" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
393     [menuItem setTag: HB_MUX_MP4];
394         // MKV file
395     menuItem = [[fDstFormatPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"MKV file" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
396     [menuItem setTag: HB_MUX_MKV];
397     
398     [fDstFormatPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
399     
400     [self formatPopUpChanged:nil];
401     
402         /* We enable the create chapters checkbox here since we are .mp4 */
403         [fCreateChapterMarkers setEnabled: YES];
404         if ([fDstFormatPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0 && [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"DefaultChapterMarkers"] > 0)
405         {
406                 [fCreateChapterMarkers setState: NSOnState];
407         }
408     
409     
410     
411     
412     [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
413                                      @"%@/Desktop/Movie.mp4", NSHomeDirectory()]];
414     
415     /* Video encoder */
416     [fVidEncoderPopUp removeAllItems];
417     [fVidEncoderPopUp addItemWithTitle: @"FFmpeg"];
418     
419     
420     /* Video quality */
421     [fVidTargetSizeField setIntValue: 700];
422         [fVidBitrateField    setIntValue: 1000];
423     
424     [fVidQualityMatrix   selectCell: fVidBitrateCell];
425     [self videoMatrixChanged:nil];
426     
427     /* Video framerate */
428     [fVidRatePopUp removeAllItems];
429         [fVidRatePopUp addItemWithTitle: NSLocalizedString( @"Same as source", @"" )];
430     for( int i = 0; i < hb_video_rates_count; i++ )
431     {
432         if ([[NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string] isEqualToString: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%.3f",23.976]])
433                 {
434                         [fVidRatePopUp addItemWithTitle:[NSString stringWithFormat: @"%@%@",
435                                              [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string], @" (NTSC Film)"]];
436                 }
437                 else if ([[NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string] isEqualToString: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d",25]])
438                 {
439                         [fVidRatePopUp addItemWithTitle:[NSString stringWithFormat: @"%@%@",
440                                              [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string], @" (PAL Film/Video)"]];
441                 }
442                 else if ([[NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string] isEqualToString: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%.2f",29.97]])
443                 {
444                         [fVidRatePopUp addItemWithTitle:[NSString stringWithFormat: @"%@%@",
445                                              [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string], @" (NTSC Video)"]];
446                 }
447                 else
448                 {
449                         [fVidRatePopUp addItemWithTitle:
450              [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_video_rates[i].string]];
451                 }
452     }
453     [fVidRatePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
454         
455         /* Set Auto Crop to On at launch */
456     [fPictureController setAutoCrop:YES];
457         
458         /* Audio bitrate */
459     [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp removeAllItems];
460     for( int i = 0; i < hb_audio_bitrates_count; i++ )
461     {
462         [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp addItemWithTitle:
463          [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_bitrates[i].string]];
464         
465     }
466     [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectItemAtIndex: hb_audio_bitrates_default];
467         
468     /* Audio samplerate */
469     [fAudTrack1RatePopUp removeAllItems];
470     for( int i = 0; i < hb_audio_rates_count; i++ )
471     {
472         [fAudTrack1RatePopUp addItemWithTitle:
473          [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_rates[i].string]];
474     }
475     [fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectItemAtIndex: hb_audio_rates_default];
476         
477     /* Bottom */
478     [fStatusField setStringValue: @""];
479     
480     [self enableUI: NO];
481         [self setupToolbar];
482     
483         /* We disable the Turbo 1st pass checkbox since we are not x264 */
484         [fVidTurboPassCheck setEnabled: NO];
485         [fVidTurboPassCheck setState: NSOffState];
486     
487     
488         /* lets get our default prefs here */
489         [self getDefaultPresets:nil];
490         /* lets initialize the current successful scancount here to 0 */
491         currentSuccessfulScanCount = 0;
492     
493     
494 }
495
496 - (void) enableUI: (bool) b
497 {
498     NSControl * controls[] =
499     { fSrcTitleField, fSrcTitlePopUp,
500         fSrcChapterField, fSrcChapterStartPopUp, fSrcChapterToField,
501         fSrcChapterEndPopUp, fSrcDuration1Field, fSrcDuration2Field,
502         fDstFormatField, fDstFormatPopUp, fDstFile1Field, fDstFile2Field,
503         fDstBrowseButton, fVidRateField, fVidRatePopUp,fVidEncoderField, fVidEncoderPopUp, fVidQualityField,
504         fPictureSizeField,fPictureCroppingField, fVideoFiltersField,fVidQualityMatrix, fSubField, fSubPopUp,
505         fAudSourceLabel, fAudCodecLabel, fAudMixdownLabel, fAudSamplerateLabel, fAudBitrateLabel,
506         fAudTrack1Label, fAudTrack2Label, fAudTrack3Label, fAudTrack4Label,
507         fAudLang1PopUp, fAudLang2PopUp, fAudLang3PopUp, fAudLang4PopUp,
508         fAudTrack1CodecPopUp, fAudTrack2CodecPopUp, fAudTrack3CodecPopUp, fAudTrack4CodecPopUp,
509         fAudTrack1MixPopUp, fAudTrack2MixPopUp, fAudTrack3MixPopUp, fAudTrack4MixPopUp,
510         fAudTrack1RatePopUp, fAudTrack2RatePopUp, fAudTrack3RatePopUp, fAudTrack4RatePopUp,
511         fAudTrack1BitratePopUp, fAudTrack2BitratePopUp, fAudTrack3BitratePopUp, fAudTrack4BitratePopUp,
512         fAudDrcLabel, fAudTrack1DrcSlider, fAudTrack1DrcField, fAudTrack2DrcSlider,
513         fAudTrack2DrcField, fAudTrack3DrcSlider, fAudTrack3DrcField, fAudTrack4DrcSlider,fAudTrack4DrcField,
514         fQueueStatus,fPresetsAdd,fPresetsDelete,fSrcAngleLabel,fSrcAnglePopUp,
515                 fCreateChapterMarkers,fVidTurboPassCheck,fDstMp4LargeFileCheck,fSubForcedCheck,fPresetsOutlineView,
516         fAudDrcLabel,fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck,fDstMp4iPodFileCheck,fVidQualityRFField,fVidQualityRFLabel,
517         fEncodeStartStopPopUp,fSrcTimeStartEncodingField,fSrcTimeEndEncodingField,fSrcFrameStartEncodingField,fSrcFrameEndEncodingField};
518     
519     for( unsigned i = 0;
520         i < sizeof( controls ) / sizeof( NSControl * ); i++ )
521     {
522         if( [[controls[i] className] isEqualToString: @"NSTextField"] )
523         {
524             NSTextField * tf = (NSTextField *) controls[i];
525             if( ![tf isBezeled] )
526             {
527                 [tf setTextColor: b ? [NSColor controlTextColor] :
528                  [NSColor disabledControlTextColor]];
529                 continue;
530             }
531         }
532         [controls[i] setEnabled: b];
533         
534     }
535     
536         if (b) {
537         
538         /* if we're enabling the interface, check if the audio mixdown controls need to be enabled or not */
539         /* these will have been enabled by the mass control enablement above anyway, so we're sense-checking it here */
540         [self setEnabledStateOfAudioMixdownControls:nil];
541         /* we also call calculatePictureSizing here to sense check if we already have vfr selected */
542         [self calculatePictureSizing:nil];
543         
544         } else {
545         
546                 [fPresetsOutlineView setEnabled: NO];
547         
548         }
549     
550     [self videoMatrixChanged:nil];
551     [fAdvancedOptions enableUI:b];
552 }
553
554
555 /***********************************************************************
556  * UpdateDockIcon
557  ***********************************************************************
558  * Shows a progression bar on the dock icon, filled according to
559  * 'progress' (0.0 <= progress <= 1.0).
560  * Called with progress < 0.0 or progress > 1.0, restores the original
561  * icon.
562  **********************************************************************/
563 - (void) UpdateDockIcon: (float) progress
564 {
565     NSData * tiff;
566     NSBitmapImageRep * bmp;
567     uint32_t * pen;
568     uint32_t black = htonl( 0x000000FF );
569     uint32_t red   = htonl( 0xFF0000FF );
570     uint32_t white = htonl( 0xFFFFFFFF );
571     int row_start, row_end;
572     int i, j;
573
574     if( progress < 0.0 || progress > 1.0 )
575     {
576         [NSApp setApplicationIconImage: fApplicationIcon];
577         return;
578     }
579
580     /* Get it in a raw bitmap form */
581     tiff = [fApplicationIcon TIFFRepresentationUsingCompression:
582             NSTIFFCompressionNone factor: 1.0];
583     bmp = [NSBitmapImageRep imageRepWithData: tiff];
584     
585     /* Draw the progression bar */
586     /* It's pretty simple (ugly?) now, but I'm no designer */
587
588     row_start = 3 * (int) [bmp size].height / 4;
589     row_end   = 7 * (int) [bmp size].height / 8;
590
591     for( i = row_start; i < row_start + 2; i++ )
592     {
593         pen = (uint32_t *) ( [bmp bitmapData] + i * [bmp bytesPerRow] );
594         for( j = 0; j < (int) [bmp size].width; j++ )
595         {
596             pen[j] = black;
597         }
598     }
599     for( i = row_start + 2; i < row_end - 2; i++ )
600     {
601         pen = (uint32_t *) ( [bmp bitmapData] + i * [bmp bytesPerRow] );
602         pen[0] = black;
603         pen[1] = black;
604         for( j = 2; j < (int) [bmp size].width - 2; j++ )
605         {
606             if( j < 2 + (int) ( ( [bmp size].width - 4.0 ) * progress ) )
607             {
608                 pen[j] = red;
609             }
610             else
611             {
612                 pen[j] = white;
613             }
614         }
615         pen[j]   = black;
616         pen[j+1] = black;
617     }
618     for( i = row_end - 2; i < row_end; i++ )
619     {
620         pen = (uint32_t *) ( [bmp bitmapData] + i * [bmp bytesPerRow] );
621         for( j = 0; j < (int) [bmp size].width; j++ )
622         {
623             pen[j] = black;
624         }
625     }
626
627     /* Now update the dock icon */
628     tiff = [bmp TIFFRepresentationUsingCompression:
629             NSTIFFCompressionNone factor: 1.0];
630     NSImage* icon = [[NSImage alloc] initWithData: tiff];
631     [NSApp setApplicationIconImage: icon];
632     [icon release];
633 }
634
635 - (void) updateUI: (NSTimer *) timer
636 {
637     
638     /* Update UI for fHandle (user scanning instance of libhb ) */
639     
640     hb_list_t  * list;
641     list = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
642     /* check to see if there has been a new scan done
643      this bypasses the constraints of HB_STATE_WORKING
644      not allowing setting a newly scanned source */
645         int checkScanCount = hb_get_scancount( fHandle );
646         if( checkScanCount > currentScanCount )
647         {
648                 currentScanCount = checkScanCount;
649         [fScanIndicator setIndeterminate: NO];
650         [fScanIndicator setDoubleValue: 0.0];
651         [fScanIndicator setHidden: YES];
652                 [self showNewScan:nil];
653         }
654     
655     hb_state_t s;
656     hb_get_state( fHandle, &s );
657     
658     switch( s.state )
659     {
660         case HB_STATE_IDLE:
661             break;
662 #define p s.param.scanning
663         case HB_STATE_SCANNING:
664                 {
665             [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
666                                             NSLocalizedString( @"Scanning title %d of %d...", @"" ),
667                                             p.title_cur, p.title_count]];
668             [fScanIndicator setHidden: NO];
669             [fScanIndicator setDoubleValue: 100.0 * ((double)( p.title_cur - 1 ) / p.title_count)];
670             break;
671                 }
672 #undef p
673             
674 #define p s.param.scandone
675         case HB_STATE_SCANDONE:
676         {
677             [fScanIndicator setIndeterminate: NO];
678             [fScanIndicator setDoubleValue: 0.0];
679             [fScanIndicator setHidden: YES];
680                         [self writeToActivityLog:"ScanDone state received from fHandle"];
681             [self showNewScan:nil];
682             [[fWindow toolbar] validateVisibleItems];
683             
684                         break;
685         }
686 #undef p
687             
688 #define p s.param.working
689         case HB_STATE_WORKING:
690         {
691             
692             break;
693         }
694 #undef p
695             
696 #define p s.param.muxing
697         case HB_STATE_MUXING:
698         {
699             
700             break;
701         }
702 #undef p
703             
704         case HB_STATE_PAUSED:
705             break;
706             
707         case HB_STATE_WORKDONE:
708         {
709             break;
710         }
711     }
712     
713     
714     /* Update UI for fQueueEncodeLibhb */
715     // hb_list_t  * list;
716     // list = hb_get_titles( fQueueEncodeLibhb ); //fQueueEncodeLibhb
717     /* check to see if there has been a new scan done
718      this bypasses the constraints of HB_STATE_WORKING
719      not allowing setting a newly scanned source */
720         
721     checkScanCount = hb_get_scancount( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
722         if( checkScanCount > currentScanCount )
723         {
724                 currentScanCount = checkScanCount;
725         }
726     
727     //hb_state_t s;
728     hb_get_state( fQueueEncodeLibhb, &s );
729     
730     switch( s.state )
731     {
732         case HB_STATE_IDLE:
733             break;
734 #define p s.param.scanning
735         case HB_STATE_SCANNING:
736                 {
737             [fStatusField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
738                                            NSLocalizedString( @"Queue Scanning title %d of %d...", @"" ),
739                                            p.title_cur, p.title_count]];
740             
741             /* Set the status string in fQueueController as well */                               
742             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: [NSString stringWithFormat:
743                                                      NSLocalizedString( @"Queue Scanning title %d of %d...", @"" ),
744                                                      p.title_cur, p.title_count]];
745             break;
746                 }
747 #undef p
748             
749 #define p s.param.scandone
750         case HB_STATE_SCANDONE:
751         {
752                         [self writeToActivityLog:"ScanDone state received from fQueueEncodeLibhb"];
753             [self processNewQueueEncode];
754             [[fWindow toolbar] validateVisibleItems];
755             
756                         break;
757         }
758 #undef p
759
760             
761 #define p s.param.working
762         
763         case HB_STATE_SEARCHING:
764                 {
765             NSMutableString * string;
766             NSString * pass_desc;
767             
768             /* Update text field */
769             pass_desc = @"";
770             //string = [NSMutableString stringWithFormat: NSLocalizedString( @"Searching for start point: pass %d %@ of %d, %.2f %%", @"" ), p.job_cur, pass_desc, p.job_count, 100.0 * p.progress];
771             /* For now, do not announce "pass x of x for the search phase ... */
772             string = [NSMutableString stringWithFormat: NSLocalizedString( @"Searching for start point ... :  %.2f %%", @"" ), 100.0 * p.progress];
773             
774                         if( p.seconds > -1 )
775             {
776                 [string appendFormat:
777                  NSLocalizedString( @" (ETA %02dh%02dm%02ds)", @"" ), p.hours, p.minutes, p.seconds];
778             }
779             
780             [fStatusField setStringValue: string];
781             /* Set the status string in fQueueController as well */
782             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: string];
783             /* Update slider */
784             CGFloat progress_total = ( p.progress + p.job_cur - 1 ) / p.job_count;
785             [fRipIndicator setIndeterminate: NO];
786             [fRipIndicator setDoubleValue:100.0 * progress_total];
787             
788             // If progress bar hasn't been revealed at the bottom of the window, do
789             // that now. This code used to be in doRip. I moved it to here to handle
790             // the case where hb_start is called by HBQueueController and not from
791             // HBController.
792             if( !fRipIndicatorShown )
793             {
794                 NSRect frame = [fWindow frame];
795                 if( frame.size.width <= 591 )
796                     frame.size.width = 591;
797                 frame.size.height += 36;
798                 frame.origin.y -= 36;
799                 [fWindow setFrame:frame display:YES animate:YES];
800                 fRipIndicatorShown = YES;
801                 
802             }
803             
804             /* Update dock icon */
805             /* Note not done yet */
806             break;  
807         }
808             
809
810         case HB_STATE_WORKING:
811         {
812             NSMutableString * string;
813             NSString * pass_desc;
814                         /* Update text field */
815             if (p.job_cur == 1 && p.job_count > 1)
816             {
817                 if ([[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SubtitleList"] && [[[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex]objectForKey:@"SubtitleList"] objectAtIndex:0] objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackNum"] intValue] == 1)
818                 {
819                     pass_desc = @"(subtitle scan)";   
820                 }
821                 else
822                 {
823                     pass_desc = @"";
824                 }
825             }
826             else
827             {
828                 pass_desc = @"";
829             }
830             
831                         string = [NSMutableString stringWithFormat: NSLocalizedString( @"Encoding: pass %d %@ of %d, %.2f %%", @"" ), p.job_cur, pass_desc, p.job_count, 100.0 * p.progress];
832             
833                         if( p.seconds > -1 )
834             {
835                 [string appendFormat:
836                  NSLocalizedString( @" (%.2f fps, avg %.2f fps, ETA %02dh%02dm%02ds)", @"" ),
837                  p.rate_cur, p.rate_avg, p.hours, p.minutes, p.seconds];
838             }
839             
840             [fStatusField setStringValue: string];
841             /* Set the status string in fQueueController as well */
842             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: string];
843             /* Update slider */
844             CGFloat progress_total = ( p.progress + p.job_cur - 1 ) / p.job_count;
845             [fRipIndicator setIndeterminate: NO];
846             [fRipIndicator setDoubleValue:100.0 * progress_total];
847             
848             // If progress bar hasn't been revealed at the bottom of the window, do
849             // that now. This code used to be in doRip. I moved it to here to handle
850             // the case where hb_start is called by HBQueueController and not from
851             // HBController.
852             if( !fRipIndicatorShown )
853             {
854                 NSRect frame = [fWindow frame];
855                 if( frame.size.width <= 591 )
856                     frame.size.width = 591;
857                 frame.size.height += 36;
858                 frame.origin.y -= 36;
859                 [fWindow setFrame:frame display:YES animate:YES];
860                 fRipIndicatorShown = YES;
861                 
862             }
863
864             /* Update dock icon */
865             if( dockIconProgress < 100.0 * progress_total )
866             {
867                 [self UpdateDockIcon: progress_total];
868                 dockIconProgress += 5;
869             }
870
871             break;
872         }
873 #undef p
874             
875 #define p s.param.muxing
876         case HB_STATE_MUXING:
877         {
878             /* Update text field */
879             [fStatusField setStringValue: NSLocalizedString( @"Muxing...", @"" )];
880             /* Set the status string in fQueueController as well */
881             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: NSLocalizedString( @"Muxing...", @"" )];
882             /* Update slider */
883             [fRipIndicator setIndeterminate: YES];
884             [fRipIndicator startAnimation: nil];
885             
886             /* Update dock icon */
887             [self UpdateDockIcon: 1.0];
888             
889                         break;
890         }
891 #undef p
892             
893         case HB_STATE_PAUSED:
894                     [fStatusField setStringValue: NSLocalizedString( @"Paused", @"" )];
895             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: NSLocalizedString( @"Paused", @"" )];
896             
897                         break;
898             
899         case HB_STATE_WORKDONE:
900         {
901             // HB_STATE_WORKDONE happpens as a result of libhb finishing all its jobs
902             // or someone calling hb_stop. In the latter case, hb_stop does not clear
903             // out the remaining passes/jobs in the queue. We'll do that here.
904             
905             // Delete all remaining jobs of this encode.
906             [fStatusField setStringValue: NSLocalizedString( @"Encode Finished.", @"" )];
907             /* Set the status string in fQueueController as well */
908             [fQueueController setQueueStatusString: NSLocalizedString( @"Encode Finished.", @"" )];
909             [fRipIndicator setIndeterminate: NO];
910             [fRipIndicator stopAnimation: nil];
911             [fRipIndicator setDoubleValue: 0.0];
912             [[fWindow toolbar] validateVisibleItems];
913             
914             /* Restore dock icon */
915             [self UpdateDockIcon: -1.0];
916             dockIconProgress = 0;
917             
918             if( fRipIndicatorShown )
919             {
920                 NSRect frame = [fWindow frame];
921                 if( frame.size.width <= 591 )
922                                     frame.size.width = 591;
923                 frame.size.height += -36;
924                 frame.origin.y -= -36;
925                 [fWindow setFrame:frame display:YES animate:YES];
926                                 fRipIndicatorShown = NO;
927                         }
928             /* Since we are done with this encode, tell output to stop writing to the
929              * individual encode log
930              */
931                         [outputPanel endEncodeLog];
932             /* Check to see if the encode state has not been cancelled
933              to determine if we should check for encode done notifications */
934                         if( fEncodeState != 2 )
935             {
936                 NSString *pathOfFinishedEncode;
937                 /* Get the output file name for the finished encode */
938                 pathOfFinishedEncode = [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"];
939                 
940                 /* Both the Growl Alert and Sending to MetaX can be done as encodes roll off the queue */
941                 /* Growl alert */
942                 [self showGrowlDoneNotification:pathOfFinishedEncode];
943                 /* Send to MetaX */
944                 [self sendToMetaX:pathOfFinishedEncode];
945                 
946                 /* since we have successfully completed an encode, we increment the queue counter */
947                 [self incrementQueueItemDone:nil]; 
948                 
949                 /* all end of queue actions below need to be done after all queue encodes have finished 
950                  * and there are no pending jobs left to process
951                  */
952                 if (fPendingCount == 0)
953                 {
954                     /* If Alert Window or Window and Growl has been selected */
955                     if( [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Alert Window"] ||
956                        [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Alert Window And Growl"] )
957                     {
958                         /*On Screen Notification*/
959                         int status;
960                         NSBeep();
961                         status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"Put down that cocktail...",@"Your HandBrake queue is done!", @"OK", nil, nil);
962                         [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
963                     }
964                     
965                     /* If sleep has been selected */
966                     if( [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Put Computer To Sleep"] )
967                     {
968                         /* Sleep */
969                         NSDictionary* errorDict;
970                         NSAppleEventDescriptor* returnDescriptor = nil;
971                         NSAppleScript* scriptObject = [[NSAppleScript alloc] initWithSource:
972                                                        @"tell application \"Finder\" to sleep"];
973                         returnDescriptor = [scriptObject executeAndReturnError: &errorDict];
974                         [scriptObject release];
975                     }
976                     /* If Shutdown has been selected */
977                     if( [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Shut Down Computer"] )
978                     {
979                         /* Shut Down */
980                         NSDictionary* errorDict;
981                         NSAppleEventDescriptor* returnDescriptor = nil;
982                         NSAppleScript* scriptObject = [[NSAppleScript alloc] initWithSource:
983                                                        @"tell application \"Finder\" to shut down"];
984                         returnDescriptor = [scriptObject executeAndReturnError: &errorDict];
985                         [scriptObject release];
986                     }
987                     
988                 }
989                 
990                 
991             }
992             
993             break;
994         }
995     }
996     
997 }
998
999 /* We use this to write messages to stderr from the macgui which show up in the activity window and log*/
1000 - (void) writeToActivityLog:(const char *) format, ...
1001 {
1002     va_list args;
1003     va_start(args, format);
1004     if (format != nil)
1005     {
1006         char str[1024];
1007         vsnprintf( str, 1024, format, args );
1008
1009         time_t _now = time( NULL );
1010         struct tm * now  = localtime( &_now );
1011         fprintf(stderr, "[%02d:%02d:%02d] macgui: %s\n", now->tm_hour, now->tm_min, now->tm_sec, str );
1012     }
1013     va_end(args);
1014 }
1015
1016 #pragma mark -
1017 #pragma mark Toolbar
1018 // ============================================================
1019 // NSToolbar Related Methods
1020 // ============================================================
1021
1022 - (void) setupToolbar {
1023     NSToolbar *toolbar = [[[NSToolbar alloc] initWithIdentifier: @"HandBrake Toolbar"] autorelease];
1024
1025     [toolbar setAllowsUserCustomization: YES];
1026     [toolbar setAutosavesConfiguration: YES];
1027     [toolbar setDisplayMode: NSToolbarDisplayModeIconAndLabel];
1028
1029     [toolbar setDelegate: self];
1030
1031     [fWindow setToolbar: toolbar];
1032 }
1033
1034 - (NSToolbarItem *) toolbar: (NSToolbar *)toolbar itemForItemIdentifier:
1035     (NSString *) itemIdent willBeInsertedIntoToolbar:(BOOL) willBeInserted {
1036     NSToolbarItem * item = [[[NSToolbarItem alloc] initWithItemIdentifier: itemIdent] autorelease];
1037
1038     if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ToggleDrawerIdentifier])
1039     {
1040         [item setLabel: @"Toggle Presets"];
1041         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Toggler Presets"];
1042         [item setToolTip: @"Open/Close Preset Drawer"];
1043         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Drawer"]];
1044         [item setTarget: self];
1045         [item setAction: @selector(toggleDrawer:)];
1046         [item setAutovalidates: NO];
1047     }
1048     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier])
1049     {
1050         [item setLabel: @"Start"];
1051         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Start Encoding"];
1052         [item setToolTip: @"Start Encoding"];
1053         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Play"]];
1054         [item setTarget: self];
1055         [item setAction: @selector(Rip:)];
1056     }
1057     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ShowQueueIdentifier])
1058     {
1059         [item setLabel: @"Show Queue"];
1060         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Show Queue"];
1061         [item setToolTip: @"Show Queue"];
1062         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Queue"]];
1063         [item setTarget: self];
1064         [item setAction: @selector(showQueueWindow:)];
1065         [item setAutovalidates: NO];
1066     }
1067     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: AddToQueueIdentifier])
1068     {
1069         [item setLabel: @"Add to Queue"];
1070         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Add to Queue"];
1071         [item setToolTip: @"Add to Queue"];
1072         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"AddToQueue"]];
1073         [item setTarget: self];
1074         [item setAction: @selector(addToQueue:)];
1075     }
1076     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: PauseEncodingIdentifier])
1077     {
1078         [item setLabel: @"Pause"];
1079         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Pause Encoding"];
1080         [item setToolTip: @"Pause Encoding"];
1081         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Pause"]];
1082         [item setTarget: self];
1083         [item setAction: @selector(Pause:)];
1084     }
1085     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ShowPictureIdentifier])
1086     {
1087         [item setLabel: @"Picture Settings"];
1088         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Show Picture Settings"];
1089         [item setToolTip: @"Show Picture Settings"];
1090         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"pref-picture"]];
1091         [item setTarget: self];
1092         [item setAction: @selector(showPicturePanel:)];
1093     }
1094     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ShowPreviewIdentifier])
1095     {
1096         [item setLabel: @"Preview Window"];
1097         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Show Preview"];
1098         [item setToolTip: @"Show Preview"];
1099         //[item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"pref-picture"]];
1100         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Brushed_Window"]];
1101         [item setTarget: self];
1102         [item setAction: @selector(showPreviewWindow:)];
1103     }
1104     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ShowActivityIdentifier]) 
1105     {
1106         [item setLabel: @"Activity Window"];
1107         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Show Activity Window"];
1108         [item setToolTip: @"Show Activity Window"];
1109         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"ActivityWindow"]];
1110         [item setTarget: self];
1111         [item setAction: @selector(showDebugOutputPanel:)];
1112         [item setAutovalidates: NO];
1113     }
1114     else if ([itemIdent isEqualToString: ChooseSourceIdentifier])
1115     {
1116         [item setLabel: @"Source"];
1117         [item setPaletteLabel: @"Source"];
1118         [item setToolTip: @"Choose Video Source"];
1119         [item setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Source"]];
1120         [item setTarget: self];
1121         [item setAction: @selector(browseSources:)];
1122     }
1123     else
1124     {
1125         return nil;
1126     }
1127
1128     return item;
1129 }
1130
1131 - (NSArray *) toolbarDefaultItemIdentifiers: (NSToolbar *) toolbar
1132 {
1133     return [NSArray arrayWithObjects: ChooseSourceIdentifier, NSToolbarSeparatorItemIdentifier, StartEncodingIdentifier,
1134         PauseEncodingIdentifier, AddToQueueIdentifier, ShowQueueIdentifier, NSToolbarFlexibleSpaceItemIdentifier, 
1135                 NSToolbarSpaceItemIdentifier, ShowPictureIdentifier, ShowPreviewIdentifier, ShowActivityIdentifier, ToggleDrawerIdentifier, nil];
1136 }
1137
1138 - (NSArray *) toolbarAllowedItemIdentifiers: (NSToolbar *) toolbar
1139 {
1140     return [NSArray arrayWithObjects:  StartEncodingIdentifier, PauseEncodingIdentifier, AddToQueueIdentifier,
1141         ChooseSourceIdentifier, ShowQueueIdentifier, ShowPictureIdentifier, ShowPreviewIdentifier, ShowActivityIdentifier, ToggleDrawerIdentifier,
1142         NSToolbarCustomizeToolbarItemIdentifier, NSToolbarFlexibleSpaceItemIdentifier,
1143         NSToolbarSpaceItemIdentifier, NSToolbarSeparatorItemIdentifier, nil];
1144 }
1145
1146 - (BOOL) validateToolbarItem: (NSToolbarItem *) toolbarItem
1147 {
1148     NSString * ident = [toolbarItem itemIdentifier];
1149         
1150     if (fHandle)
1151     {
1152         hb_state_t s;
1153         
1154         hb_get_state( fHandle, &s );
1155         if (s.state == HB_STATE_SCANNING)
1156         {
1157             
1158             if ([ident isEqualToString: ChooseSourceIdentifier])
1159             {
1160                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Stop"]];
1161                 [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Cancel Scan"];
1162                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Cancel Scanning"];
1163                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Cancel Scanning Source"];
1164                 return YES;
1165             }
1166             
1167             if ([ident isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier] || [ident isEqualToString: AddToQueueIdentifier])
1168                 return NO;
1169         }
1170         else
1171         {
1172             if ([ident isEqualToString: ChooseSourceIdentifier])
1173             {
1174                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Source"]];
1175                 [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Source"];
1176                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Source"];
1177                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Choose Video Source"];
1178                 return YES;
1179             }
1180         }
1181
1182         hb_get_state2( fQueueEncodeLibhb, &s );
1183         
1184         if (s.state == HB_STATE_WORKING || s.state == HB_STATE_SEARCHING || s.state == HB_STATE_MUXING)
1185         {
1186             if ([ident isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier])
1187             {
1188                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Stop"]];
1189                 [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Stop"];
1190                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Stop"];
1191                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Stop Encoding"];
1192                 return YES;
1193             }
1194             if ([ident isEqualToString: PauseEncodingIdentifier])
1195             {
1196                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Pause"]];
1197                 [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Pause"];
1198                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Pause Encoding"];
1199                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Pause Encoding"];
1200                 return YES;
1201             }
1202             if (SuccessfulScan)
1203             {
1204                 if ([ident isEqualToString: AddToQueueIdentifier])
1205                     return YES;
1206                 if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPictureIdentifier])
1207                     return YES;
1208                 if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPreviewIdentifier])
1209                     return YES;
1210             }
1211         }
1212         else if (s.state == HB_STATE_PAUSED)
1213         {
1214             if ([ident isEqualToString: PauseEncodingIdentifier])
1215             {
1216                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Play"]];
1217                 [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Resume"];
1218                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Resume Encoding"];
1219                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Resume Encoding"];
1220                 return YES;
1221             }
1222             if ([ident isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier])
1223                 return YES;
1224             if ([ident isEqualToString: AddToQueueIdentifier])
1225                 return YES;
1226             if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPictureIdentifier])
1227                 return YES;
1228             if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPreviewIdentifier])
1229                 return YES;
1230         }
1231         else if (s.state == HB_STATE_SCANNING)
1232             return NO;
1233         else if (s.state == HB_STATE_WORKDONE || s.state == HB_STATE_SCANDONE || SuccessfulScan)
1234         {
1235             if ([ident isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier])
1236             {
1237                 [toolbarItem setImage: [NSImage imageNamed: @"Play"]];
1238                 if (hb_count(fHandle) > 0)
1239                     [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Start Queue"];
1240                 else
1241                     [toolbarItem setLabel: @"Start"];
1242                 [toolbarItem setPaletteLabel: @"Start Encoding"];
1243                 [toolbarItem setToolTip: @"Start Encoding"];
1244                 return YES;
1245             }
1246             if ([ident isEqualToString: AddToQueueIdentifier])
1247                 return YES;
1248             if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPictureIdentifier])
1249                 return YES;
1250             if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowPreviewIdentifier])
1251                 return YES;
1252         }
1253
1254     }
1255     /* If there are any pending queue items, make sure the start/stop button is active */
1256     if ([ident isEqualToString: StartEncodingIdentifier] && fPendingCount > 0)
1257         return YES;
1258     if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowQueueIdentifier])
1259         return YES;
1260     if ([ident isEqualToString: ToggleDrawerIdentifier])
1261         return YES;
1262     if ([ident isEqualToString: ChooseSourceIdentifier])
1263         return YES;
1264     if ([ident isEqualToString: ShowActivityIdentifier])
1265         return YES;
1266     
1267     return NO;
1268 }
1269
1270 - (BOOL) validateMenuItem: (NSMenuItem *) menuItem
1271 {
1272     SEL action = [menuItem action];
1273     
1274     hb_state_t s;
1275     hb_get_state2( fHandle, &s );
1276     
1277     if (fHandle)
1278     {
1279         if (action == @selector(addToQueue:) || action == @selector(showPicturePanel:) || action == @selector(showAddPresetPanel:))
1280             return SuccessfulScan && [fWindow attachedSheet] == nil;
1281         
1282         if (action == @selector(browseSources:))
1283         {
1284             if (s.state == HB_STATE_SCANNING)
1285                 return NO;
1286             else
1287                 return [fWindow attachedSheet] == nil;
1288         }
1289         if (action == @selector(selectDefaultPreset:))
1290             return [fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow] >= 0 && [fWindow attachedSheet] == nil;
1291         if (action == @selector(Pause:))
1292         {
1293             if (s.state == HB_STATE_WORKING)
1294             {
1295                 if(![[menuItem title] isEqualToString:@"Pause Encoding"])
1296                     [menuItem setTitle:@"Pause Encoding"];
1297                 return YES;
1298             }
1299             else if (s.state == HB_STATE_PAUSED)
1300             {
1301                 if(![[menuItem title] isEqualToString:@"Resume Encoding"])
1302                     [menuItem setTitle:@"Resume Encoding"];
1303                 return YES;
1304             }
1305             else
1306                 return NO;
1307         }
1308         if (action == @selector(Rip:))
1309         {
1310             if (s.state == HB_STATE_WORKING || s.state == HB_STATE_MUXING || s.state == HB_STATE_PAUSED)
1311             {
1312                 if(![[menuItem title] isEqualToString:@"Stop Encoding"])
1313                     [menuItem setTitle:@"Stop Encoding"];
1314                 return YES;
1315             }
1316             else if (SuccessfulScan)
1317             {
1318                 if(![[menuItem title] isEqualToString:@"Start Encoding"])
1319                     [menuItem setTitle:@"Start Encoding"];
1320                 return [fWindow attachedSheet] == nil;
1321             }
1322             else
1323                 return NO;
1324         }
1325     }
1326     if( action == @selector(setDefaultPreset:) )
1327     {
1328         return [fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow] != -1;
1329     }
1330
1331     return YES;
1332 }
1333
1334 #pragma mark -
1335 #pragma mark Encode Done Actions
1336 // register a test notification and make
1337 // it enabled by default
1338 #define SERVICE_NAME @"Encode Done"
1339 - (NSDictionary *)registrationDictionaryForGrowl 
1340
1341     NSDictionary *registrationDictionary = [NSDictionary dictionaryWithObjectsAndKeys: 
1342     [NSArray arrayWithObjects:SERVICE_NAME,nil], GROWL_NOTIFICATIONS_ALL, 
1343     [NSArray arrayWithObjects:SERVICE_NAME,nil], GROWL_NOTIFICATIONS_DEFAULT, 
1344     nil]; 
1345
1346     return registrationDictionary; 
1347
1348
1349 -(void)showGrowlDoneNotification:(NSString *) filePath
1350 {
1351     /* This end of encode action is called as each encode rolls off of the queue */
1352     NSString * finishedEncode = filePath;
1353     /* strip off the path to just show the file name */
1354     finishedEncode = [finishedEncode lastPathComponent];
1355     if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Growl Notification"] || 
1356         [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Alert Window And Growl"])
1357     {
1358         NSString * growlMssg = [NSString stringWithFormat: @"your HandBrake encode %@ is done!",finishedEncode];
1359         [GrowlApplicationBridge 
1360          notifyWithTitle:@"Put down that cocktail..." 
1361          description:growlMssg 
1362          notificationName:SERVICE_NAME
1363          iconData:nil 
1364          priority:0 
1365          isSticky:1 
1366          clickContext:nil];
1367     }
1368     
1369 }
1370 -(void)sendToMetaX:(NSString *) filePath
1371 {
1372     /* This end of encode action is called as each encode rolls off of the queue */
1373     if([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"sendToMetaX"] == YES)
1374     {
1375         NSString *sendToApp = [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey: @"SendCompletedEncodeToApp"];
1376         if (![sendToApp isEqualToString:@"None"])
1377         {
1378             [self writeToActivityLog: "trying to send encode to: %s", [sendToApp UTF8String]];
1379             NSAppleScript *myScript = [[NSAppleScript alloc] initWithSource: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%@%@%@%@%@", @"tell application \"",sendToApp,@"\" to open (POSIX file \"", filePath, @"\")"]];
1380             [myScript executeAndReturnError: nil];
1381             [myScript release];
1382         }
1383         
1384     }
1385 }
1386 #pragma mark -
1387 #pragma mark Get New Source
1388
1389 /*Opens the source browse window, called from Open Source widgets */
1390 - (IBAction) browseSources: (id) sender
1391 {
1392     
1393     hb_state_t s;
1394     hb_get_state( fHandle, &s );
1395     if (s.state == HB_STATE_SCANNING)
1396     {
1397         [self cancelScanning:nil];
1398         return;
1399     }
1400     
1401     
1402     NSOpenPanel * panel;
1403         
1404     panel = [NSOpenPanel openPanel];
1405     [panel setAllowsMultipleSelection: NO];
1406     [panel setCanChooseFiles: YES];
1407     [panel setCanChooseDirectories: YES ];
1408     NSString * sourceDirectory;
1409         if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastSourceDirectory"])
1410         {
1411                 sourceDirectory = [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastSourceDirectory"];
1412         }
1413         else
1414         {
1415                 sourceDirectory = @"~/Desktop";
1416                 sourceDirectory = [sourceDirectory stringByExpandingTildeInPath];
1417         }
1418     /* we open up the browse sources sheet here and call for browseSourcesDone after the sheet is closed
1419         * to evaluate whether we want to specify a title, we pass the sender in the contextInfo variable
1420         */
1421     [panel beginSheetForDirectory: sourceDirectory file: nil types: nil
1422                    modalForWindow: fWindow modalDelegate: self
1423                    didEndSelector: @selector( browseSourcesDone:returnCode:contextInfo: )
1424                       contextInfo: sender]; 
1425 }
1426
1427 - (void) browseSourcesDone: (NSOpenPanel *) sheet
1428                 returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
1429 {
1430     /* we convert the sender content of contextInfo back into a variable called sender
1431      * mostly just for consistency for evaluation later
1432      */
1433     id sender = (id)contextInfo;
1434     /* User selected a file to open */
1435         if( returnCode == NSOKButton )
1436     {
1437             /* Free display name allocated previously by this code */
1438         [browsedSourceDisplayName release];
1439        
1440         NSString *scanPath = [[sheet filenames] objectAtIndex: 0];
1441         /* we set the last searched source directory in the prefs here */
1442         NSString *sourceDirectory = [scanPath stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
1443         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:sourceDirectory forKey:@"LastSourceDirectory"];
1444         /* we order out sheet, which is the browse window as we need to open
1445          * the title selection sheet right away
1446          */
1447         [sheet orderOut: self];
1448         
1449         if (sender == fOpenSourceTitleMMenu || [[NSApp currentEvent] modifierFlags] & NSAlternateKeyMask)
1450         {
1451             /* We put the chosen source path in the source display text field for the
1452              * source title selection sheet in which the user specifies the specific title to be
1453              * scanned  as well as the short source name in fSrcDsplyNameTitleScan just for display
1454              * purposes in the title panel
1455              */
1456             /* Full Path */
1457             [fScanSrcTitlePathField setStringValue:scanPath];
1458             NSString *displayTitlescanSourceName;
1459
1460             if ([[scanPath lastPathComponent] isEqualToString: @"VIDEO_TS"])
1461             {
1462                 /* If VIDEO_TS Folder is chosen, choose its parent folder for the source display name
1463                  we have to use the title->path value so we get the proper name of the volume if a physical dvd is the source*/
1464                 displayTitlescanSourceName = [[scanPath stringByDeletingLastPathComponent] lastPathComponent];
1465             }
1466             else
1467             {
1468                 /* if not the VIDEO_TS Folder, we can assume the chosen folder is the source name */
1469                 displayTitlescanSourceName = [scanPath lastPathComponent];
1470             }
1471             /* we set the source display name in the title selection dialogue */
1472             [fSrcDsplyNameTitleScan setStringValue:displayTitlescanSourceName];
1473             /* we set the attempted scans display name for main window to displayTitlescanSourceName*/
1474             browsedSourceDisplayName = [displayTitlescanSourceName retain];
1475             /* We show the actual sheet where the user specifies the title to be scanned
1476              * as we are going to do a title specific scan
1477              */
1478             [self showSourceTitleScanPanel:nil];
1479         }
1480         else
1481         {
1482             /* We are just doing a standard full source scan, so we specify "0" to libhb */
1483             NSString *path = [[sheet filenames] objectAtIndex: 0];
1484             
1485             /* We check to see if the chosen file at path is a package */
1486             if ([[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] isFilePackageAtPath:path])
1487             {
1488                 [self writeToActivityLog: "trying to open a package at: %s", [path UTF8String]];
1489                 /* We check to see if this is an .eyetv package */
1490                 if ([[path pathExtension] isEqualToString: @"eyetv"])
1491                 {
1492                     [self writeToActivityLog:"trying to open eyetv package"];
1493                     /* We're looking at an EyeTV package - try to open its enclosed
1494                      .mpg media file */
1495                      browsedSourceDisplayName = [[[path stringByDeletingPathExtension] lastPathComponent] retain];
1496                     NSString *mpgname;
1497                     int n = [[path stringByAppendingString: @"/"]
1498                              completePathIntoString: &mpgname caseSensitive: YES
1499                              matchesIntoArray: nil
1500                              filterTypes: [NSArray arrayWithObject: @"mpg"]];
1501                     if (n > 0)
1502                     {
1503                         /* Found an mpeg inside the eyetv package, make it our scan path 
1504                         and call performScan on the enclosed mpeg */
1505                         path = mpgname;
1506                         [self writeToActivityLog:"found mpeg in eyetv package"];
1507                         [self performScan:path scanTitleNum:0];
1508                     }
1509                     else
1510                     {
1511                         /* We did not find an mpeg file in our package, so we do not call performScan */
1512                         [self writeToActivityLog:"no valid mpeg in eyetv package"];
1513                     }
1514                 }
1515                 /* We check to see if this is a .dvdmedia package */
1516                 else if ([[path pathExtension] isEqualToString: @"dvdmedia"])
1517                 {
1518                     /* path IS a package - but dvdmedia packages can be treaded like normal directories */
1519                     browsedSourceDisplayName = [[[path stringByDeletingPathExtension] lastPathComponent] retain];
1520                     [self writeToActivityLog:"trying to open dvdmedia package"];
1521                     [self performScan:path scanTitleNum:0];
1522                 }
1523                 else
1524                 {
1525                     /* The package is not an eyetv package, so we do not call performScan */
1526                     [self writeToActivityLog:"unable to open package"];
1527                 }
1528             }
1529             else // path is not a package, so we treat it as a dvd parent folder or VIDEO_TS folder
1530             {
1531                 /* path is not a package, so we call perform scan directly on our file */
1532                 if ([[path lastPathComponent] isEqualToString: @"VIDEO_TS"])
1533                 {
1534                     [self writeToActivityLog:"trying to open video_ts folder (video_ts folder chosen)"];
1535                     /* If VIDEO_TS Folder is chosen, choose its parent folder for the source display name*/
1536                     browsedSourceDisplayName = [[[path stringByDeletingLastPathComponent] lastPathComponent] retain];
1537                 }
1538                 else
1539                 {
1540                     [self writeToActivityLog:"trying to open video_ts folder (parent directory chosen)"];
1541                     /* if not the VIDEO_TS Folder, we can assume the chosen folder is the source name */
1542                     /* make sure we remove any path extension as this can also be an '.mpg' file */
1543                     browsedSourceDisplayName = [[path lastPathComponent] retain];
1544                 }
1545                 applyQueueToScan = NO;
1546                 [self performScan:path scanTitleNum:0];
1547             }
1548
1549         }
1550
1551     }
1552 }
1553
1554 - (IBAction)showAboutPanel:(id)sender
1555 {
1556     NSMutableDictionary* d = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] initWithObjectsAndKeys:
1557         fApplicationIcon, @"ApplicationIcon",
1558         nil ];
1559     [NSApp orderFrontStandardAboutPanelWithOptions:d];
1560     [d release];
1561 }
1562
1563 /* Here we open the title selection sheet where we can specify an exact title to be scanned */
1564 - (IBAction) showSourceTitleScanPanel: (id) sender
1565 {
1566     /* We default the title number to be scanned to "0" which results in a full source scan, unless the
1567     * user changes it
1568     */
1569     [fScanSrcTitleNumField setStringValue: @"0"];
1570         /* Show the panel */
1571         [NSApp beginSheet:fScanSrcTitlePanel modalForWindow:fWindow modalDelegate:nil didEndSelector:NULL contextInfo:NULL];
1572 }
1573
1574 - (IBAction) closeSourceTitleScanPanel: (id) sender
1575 {
1576     [NSApp endSheet: fScanSrcTitlePanel];
1577     [fScanSrcTitlePanel orderOut: self];
1578     
1579     if(sender == fScanSrcTitleOpenButton)
1580     {
1581         /* We setup the scan status in the main window to indicate a source title scan */
1582         [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue: @"Opening a new source title ..."];
1583                 [fScanIndicator setHidden: NO];
1584         [fScanIndicator setIndeterminate: YES];
1585         [fScanIndicator startAnimation: nil];
1586                 
1587         /* We use the performScan method to actually perform the specified scan passing the path and the title
1588          * to be scanned
1589          */
1590         applyQueueToScan = NO;
1591         [self performScan:[fScanSrcTitlePathField stringValue] scanTitleNum:[fScanSrcTitleNumField intValue]];
1592     }
1593 }
1594
1595 /* Here we actually tell hb_scan to perform the source scan, using the path to source and title number*/
1596 - (void) performScan:(NSString *) scanPath scanTitleNum: (int) scanTitleNum
1597 {
1598     
1599     /* use a bool to determine whether or not we can decrypt using vlc */
1600     BOOL cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
1601     BOOL vlcFound = 0;
1602     NSString *path = scanPath;
1603     HBDVDDetector *detector = [HBDVDDetector detectorForPath:path];
1604     
1605     // Notify ChapterTitles that there's no title
1606     [fChapterTitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:nil];
1607     [fChapterTable reloadData];
1608     
1609     // Notify Subtitles that there's no title
1610     [fSubtitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:nil];
1611     [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];
1612     
1613     [self enableUI: NO];
1614     
1615     if( [detector isVideoDVD] )
1616     {
1617         int hb_arch;
1618 #if defined( __LP64__ )
1619         /* we are 64 bit */
1620         hb_arch = 64;
1621 #else
1622         /* we are 32 bit */
1623         hb_arch = 32;
1624 #endif 
1625         
1626         
1627         // The chosen path was actually on a DVD, so use the raw block
1628         // device path instead.
1629         path = [detector devicePath];
1630         [self writeToActivityLog: "trying to open a physical dvd at: %s", [scanPath UTF8String]];
1631         
1632         /* lets check for vlc here to make sure we have a dylib available to use for decrypting */
1633         NSString *vlcPath = @"/Applications/VLC.app/Contents/MacOS/lib/libdvdcss.2.dylib";
1634         NSFileManager * fileManager = [NSFileManager defaultManager];
1635             if ([fileManager fileExistsAtPath:vlcPath] == 0) 
1636             {
1637             /*vlc not found in /Applications so we set the bool to cancel scanning to 1 */
1638             cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
1639             [self writeToActivityLog: "VLC app not found for decrypting physical dvd"];
1640             int status;
1641             status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"HandBrake could not find VLC or your VLC is out of date.",@"Please download and install VLC media player in your /Applications folder if you wish to read encrypted DVDs.", @"Get VLC", @"Cancel Scan", @"Attempt Scan Anyway");
1642             [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
1643             
1644             if (status == NSAlertDefaultReturn)
1645             {
1646                 /* User chose to go download vlc (as they rightfully should) so we send them to the vlc site */
1647                 [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL:[NSURL URLWithString:@"http://www.videolan.org/vlc/download-macosx.html"]];
1648             }
1649             else if (status == NSAlertAlternateReturn)
1650             {
1651                 /* User chose to cancel the scan */
1652                 [self writeToActivityLog: "cannot open physical dvd , scan cancelled"];
1653             }
1654             else
1655             {
1656                 /* User chose to override our warning and scan the physical dvd anyway, at their own peril. on an encrypted dvd this produces massive log files and fails */
1657                 cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
1658                 [self writeToActivityLog: "user overrode vlc warning -trying to open physical dvd without decryption"];
1659             }
1660             
1661         }
1662         else
1663         {
1664             /* VLC was found in /Applications so all is well, we can carry on using vlc's libdvdcss.dylib for decrypting if needed */
1665             [self writeToActivityLog: "VLC app found for decrypting physical dvd"];
1666             vlcFound = 1;
1667         }
1668         /* test for architecture of the vlc app */
1669         NSArray *vlc_architecturesArray = [[NSBundle bundleWithPath:@"/Applications/VLC.app"] executableArchitectures];
1670         BOOL vlcIntel32bit = NO;
1671         BOOL vlcIntel64bit = NO;
1672         BOOL vlcPPC32bit = NO;
1673         BOOL vlcPPC64bit = NO;
1674         /* check the available architectures for vlc and note accordingly */
1675         NSEnumerator *enumerator = [vlc_architecturesArray objectEnumerator];
1676         id tempObject;
1677         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
1678         {
1679             
1680             if ([tempObject intValue] == NSBundleExecutableArchitectureI386)
1681             {
1682                 vlcIntel32bit = YES;   
1683             }
1684             if ([tempObject intValue] == NSBundleExecutableArchitectureX86_64)
1685             {
1686                 vlcIntel64bit = YES;   
1687             }
1688             if ([tempObject intValue] == NSBundleExecutableArchitecturePPC)
1689             {
1690                 vlcPPC32bit = YES;   
1691             }
1692             if ([tempObject intValue] == NSBundleExecutableArchitecturePPC64)
1693             {
1694                 vlcPPC64bit = YES;   
1695             }
1696             
1697         }
1698         /* Write vlc architecture findings to activity window */
1699         if (vlcIntel32bit)
1700         {
1701             [self writeToActivityLog: " 32-Bit VLC app found for decrypting physical dvd"];
1702         }
1703         if (vlcIntel64bit)
1704         {
1705             [self writeToActivityLog: " 64-Bit VLC app found for decrypting physical dvd"];
1706         }
1707         
1708         
1709         
1710         if (vlcFound && hb_arch == 64 && !vlcIntel64bit && cancelScanDecrypt != 1)
1711         {
1712             
1713             /* we are 64 bit */
1714             
1715             /* Appropriate VLC not found, so cancel */
1716             cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
1717             [self writeToActivityLog: "This version of HandBrake is 64 bit, 64 bit version of vlc not found, scan cancelled"];
1718             /*On Screen Notification*/
1719             int status;
1720             NSBeep();
1721             status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"This version of HandBrake is 64 bit, VLC found but not 64 bit!",@"", @"Cancel Scan", @"Attempt Scan Anyway", @"Get 64 bit VLC", nil);
1722             [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
1723             
1724             if (status == NSAlertDefaultReturn)
1725             {
1726                 /* User chose to cancel the scan */
1727                 [self writeToActivityLog: "cannot open physical dvd VLC found but not 64 bit, scan cancelled"];
1728                 cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
1729             }
1730             else if (status == NSAlertAlternateReturn)
1731             {
1732                 [self writeToActivityLog: "user overrode 64-bit warning trying to open physical dvd without proper decryption"];
1733                 cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
1734             }
1735             else
1736             {
1737                 /* User chose to go download vlc (as they rightfully should) so we send them to the vlc site */
1738                 [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL:[NSURL URLWithString:@"http://www.videolan.org/vlc/download-macosx.html"]];
1739             }
1740             
1741         }    
1742         else if (vlcFound && hb_arch == 32 && !vlcIntel32bit && cancelScanDecrypt != 1)
1743         {
1744             /* we are 32 bit */
1745             /* Appropriate VLC not found, so cancel */
1746             cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
1747             [self writeToActivityLog: "This version of HandBrake is 32 bit, 32 bit version of vlc not found, scan cancelled"];
1748             /*On Screen Notification*/
1749             int status;
1750             NSBeep();
1751             status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"This version of HandBrake is 32 bit, VLC found but not 32 bit!",@"", @"Cancel Scan", @"Attempt Scan Anyway", @"Get 32 bit VLC", nil);
1752             [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
1753             
1754             if (status == NSAlertDefaultReturn)
1755             {
1756                 /* User chose to cancel the scan */
1757                 [self writeToActivityLog: "cannot open physical dvd VLC found but not 32 bit, scan cancelled"];
1758                 cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
1759             }
1760             else if (status == NSAlertAlternateReturn)
1761             {
1762                 [self writeToActivityLog: "user overrode 32-bit warning trying to open physical dvd without proper decryption"];
1763                 cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
1764             }
1765             else
1766             {
1767                 /* User chose to go download vlc (as they rightfully should) so we send them to the vlc site */
1768                 [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL:[NSURL URLWithString:@"http://www.videolan.org/vlc/download-macosx.html"]];
1769             }
1770             
1771         } 
1772     }
1773     
1774     if (cancelScanDecrypt == 0)
1775     {
1776         /* we actually pass the scan off to libhb here */
1777         /* If there is no title number passed to scan, we use "0"
1778          * which causes the default behavior of a full source scan
1779          */
1780         if (!scanTitleNum)
1781         {
1782             scanTitleNum = 0;
1783         }
1784         if (scanTitleNum > 0)
1785         {
1786             [self writeToActivityLog: "scanning specifically for title: %d", scanTitleNum];
1787         }
1788         /* We use our advance pref to determine how many previews to scan */
1789         int hb_num_previews = [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey:@"PreviewsNumber"] intValue];
1790         /* set title to NULL */
1791         fTitle = NULL;
1792         hb_scan( fHandle, [path UTF8String], scanTitleNum, hb_num_previews, 1 );
1793         [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue:@"Scanning new source ..."];
1794     }
1795 }
1796
1797 - (IBAction) cancelScanning:(id)sender
1798 {
1799     hb_scan_stop(fHandle);
1800 }
1801
1802 - (IBAction) showNewScan:(id)sender
1803 {
1804     hb_list_t  * list;
1805         hb_title_t * title;
1806         int indxpri=0;    // Used to search the longuest title (default in combobox)
1807         int longuestpri=0; // Used to search the longuest title (default in combobox)
1808     
1809
1810         list = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
1811         
1812         if( !hb_list_count( list ) )
1813         {
1814             /* We display a message if a valid dvd source was not chosen */
1815             [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue: @"No Valid Source Found"];
1816             SuccessfulScan = NO;
1817             
1818             // Notify ChapterTitles that there's no title
1819             [fSubtitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:nil];
1820             [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];
1821             
1822             // Notify Subtitles that there's no title
1823             [fChapterTitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:nil];
1824             [fChapterTable reloadData];
1825         }
1826         else
1827         {
1828             if (applyQueueToScan == YES)
1829             {
1830                 /* we are a rescan of an existing queue item and need to apply the queued settings to the scan */
1831                 [self writeToActivityLog: "showNewScan: This is a queued item rescan"];
1832                 
1833             }
1834             else if (applyQueueToScan == NO)
1835             {
1836                 [self writeToActivityLog: "showNewScan: This is a new source item scan"];
1837             }
1838             else
1839             {
1840                 [self writeToActivityLog: "showNewScan: cannot grok scan status"];
1841             }
1842             
1843               /* We increment the successful scancount here by one,
1844              which we use at the end of this function to tell the gui
1845              if this is the first successful scan since launch and whether
1846              or not we should set all settings to the defaults */
1847             currentSuccessfulScanCount++;
1848             
1849             [[fWindow toolbar] validateVisibleItems];
1850             
1851             [fSrcTitlePopUp removeAllItems];
1852             for( int i = 0; i < hb_list_count( list ); i++ )
1853             {
1854                 title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list, i );
1855                 
1856                 currentSource = [NSString stringWithUTF8String: title->name];
1857                 /*Set DVD Name at top of window with the browsedSourceDisplayName grokked right before -performScan */
1858                 if (!browsedSourceDisplayName)
1859                 {
1860                     browsedSourceDisplayName = @"NoNameDetected";
1861                 }
1862                 [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue:browsedSourceDisplayName];
1863                 
1864                 /* If its a queue rescan for edit, get the queue item output path */
1865                 /* if not, its a new source scan. */
1866                 /* Check to see if the last destination has been set,use if so, if not, use Desktop */
1867                 if (applyQueueToScan == YES)
1868                 {
1869                     [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"%@", [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:fqueueEditRescanItemNum] objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"]]];
1870                 }
1871                 else if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastDestinationDirectory"])
1872                 {
1873                     [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
1874                                                      @"%@/%@.mp4", [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastDestinationDirectory"],[browsedSourceDisplayName stringByDeletingPathExtension]]];
1875                 }
1876                 else
1877                 {
1878                     [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
1879                                                      @"%@/Desktop/%@.mp4", NSHomeDirectory(),[browsedSourceDisplayName stringByDeletingPathExtension]]];
1880                 }
1881                 
1882                 
1883                 if (longuestpri < title->hours*60*60 + title->minutes *60 + title->seconds)
1884                 {
1885                     longuestpri=title->hours*60*60 + title->minutes *60 + title->seconds;
1886                     indxpri=i;
1887                 }
1888                 
1889                 [fSrcTitlePopUp addItemWithTitle: [NSString
1890                                                    stringWithFormat: @"%s %d - %02dh%02dm%02ds",
1891                                                    title->name,title->index, title->hours, title->minutes,
1892                                                    title->seconds]];
1893             }
1894             
1895             /* if we are a stream, select the first title */
1896             if (title->type == HB_STREAM_TYPE)
1897             {
1898                 [fSrcTitlePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
1899             }
1900             else
1901             {
1902                 /* if not then select the longest title (dvd) */
1903                 [fSrcTitlePopUp selectItemAtIndex: indxpri];
1904             }
1905             [self titlePopUpChanged:nil];
1906             
1907             SuccessfulScan = YES;
1908             [self enableUI: YES];
1909
1910             /* if its the initial successful scan after awakeFromNib */
1911             if (currentSuccessfulScanCount == 1)
1912             {
1913                 [self encodeStartStopPopUpChanged:nil];
1914                 
1915                 [self selectDefaultPreset:nil];
1916                 
1917                 // Open preview window now if it was visible when HB was closed
1918                 if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"PreviewWindowIsOpen"])
1919                     [self showPreviewWindow:nil];
1920                 
1921                 // Open picture sizing window now if it was visible when HB was closed
1922                 if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"PictureSizeWindowIsOpen"])
1923                     [self showPicturePanel:nil];
1924                 
1925             }
1926             if (applyQueueToScan == YES)
1927             {
1928                 /* we are a rescan of an existing queue item and need to apply the queued settings to the scan */
1929                 [self writeToActivityLog: "showNewScan: calling applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow"];
1930                 [self applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow:nil];
1931                 
1932             }
1933
1934             
1935         }
1936
1937 }
1938
1939
1940 #pragma mark -
1941 #pragma mark New Output Destination
1942
1943 - (IBAction) browseFile: (id) sender
1944 {
1945     /* Open a panel to let the user choose and update the text field */
1946     NSSavePanel * panel = [NSSavePanel savePanel];
1947         /* We get the current file name and path from the destination field here */
1948         [panel beginSheetForDirectory: [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent] file: [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] lastPathComponent]
1949                                    modalForWindow: fWindow modalDelegate: self
1950                                    didEndSelector: @selector( browseFileDone:returnCode:contextInfo: )
1951                                           contextInfo: NULL];
1952 }
1953
1954 - (void) browseFileDone: (NSSavePanel *) sheet
1955              returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
1956 {
1957     if( returnCode == NSOKButton )
1958     {
1959         [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [sheet filename]];
1960         /* Save this path to the prefs so that on next browse destination window it opens there */
1961         NSString *destinationDirectory = [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
1962         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:destinationDirectory forKey:@"LastDestinationDirectory"];   
1963     }
1964 }
1965
1966
1967 #pragma mark -
1968 #pragma mark Main Window Control
1969
1970 - (IBAction) openMainWindow: (id) sender
1971 {
1972     [fWindow  makeKeyAndOrderFront:nil];
1973 }
1974
1975 - (BOOL) windowShouldClose: (id) sender
1976 {
1977     return YES;
1978 }
1979
1980 - (BOOL)applicationShouldHandleReopen:(NSApplication *)theApplication hasVisibleWindows:(BOOL)flag
1981 {
1982     if( !flag ) {
1983         [fWindow  makeKeyAndOrderFront:nil];
1984                 
1985         return YES;
1986     }
1987     
1988     return NO;
1989 }
1990
1991 - (NSSize) drawerWillResizeContents:(NSDrawer *) drawer toSize:(NSSize) contentSize {
1992         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:NSStringFromSize( contentSize ) forKey:@"Drawer Size"];
1993         return contentSize;
1994 }
1995
1996 #pragma mark -
1997 #pragma mark Queue File
1998
1999 - (void) loadQueueFile {
2000         /* We declare the default NSFileManager into fileManager */
2001         NSFileManager * fileManager = [NSFileManager defaultManager];
2002         /*We define the location of the user presets file */
2003     QueueFile = @"~/Library/Application Support/HandBrake/Queue.plist";
2004         QueueFile = [[QueueFile stringByExpandingTildeInPath]retain];
2005     /* We check for the presets.plist */
2006         if ([fileManager fileExistsAtPath:QueueFile] == 0)
2007         {
2008                 [fileManager createFileAtPath:QueueFile contents:nil attributes:nil];
2009         }
2010
2011         QueueFileArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:QueueFile];
2012         /* lets check to see if there is anything in the queue file .plist */
2013     if (nil == QueueFileArray)
2014         {
2015         /* if not, then lets initialize an empty array */
2016                 QueueFileArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
2017         
2018      /* Initialize our curQueueEncodeIndex to 0
2019      * so we can use it to track which queue
2020      * item is to be used to track our encodes */
2021      /* NOTE: this should be changed if and when we
2022       * are able to get the last unfinished encode
2023       * in the case of a crash or shutdown */
2024     
2025         }
2026     else
2027     {
2028     [self clearQueueEncodedItems];
2029     }
2030     currentQueueEncodeIndex = 0;
2031 }
2032
2033 - (void)addQueueFileItem
2034 {
2035         [QueueFileArray addObject:[self createQueueFileItem]];
2036         [self saveQueueFileItem];
2037
2038 }
2039
2040 - (void) removeQueueFileItem:(int) queueItemToRemove
2041 {
2042    
2043    /* Find out if the item we are removing is a cancelled (3) or a finished (0) item*/
2044    if ([[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:queueItemToRemove] objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 3 || [[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:queueItemToRemove] objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 0)
2045     {
2046     /* Since we are removing a cancelled or finished item, WE need to decrement the currentQueueEncodeIndex
2047      * by one to keep in sync with the queue array
2048      */
2049     currentQueueEncodeIndex--;
2050     [self writeToActivityLog: "removeQueueFileItem: Removing a cancelled/finished encode, decrement currentQueueEncodeIndex to %d", currentQueueEncodeIndex];
2051     }
2052     [QueueFileArray removeObjectAtIndex:queueItemToRemove];
2053     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2054
2055 }
2056
2057 - (void)saveQueueFileItem
2058 {
2059     [QueueFileArray writeToFile:QueueFile atomically:YES];
2060     [fQueueController setQueueArray: QueueFileArray];
2061     [self getQueueStats];
2062 }
2063
2064 - (void)getQueueStats
2065 {
2066 /* lets get the stats on the status of the queue array */
2067
2068 fEncodingQueueItem = 0;
2069 fPendingCount = 0;
2070 fCompletedCount = 0;
2071 fCanceledCount = 0;
2072 fWorkingCount = 0;
2073
2074     /* We use a number system to set the encode status of the queue item
2075      * in controller.mm
2076      * 0 == already encoded
2077      * 1 == is being encoded
2078      * 2 == is yet to be encoded
2079      * 3 == cancelled
2080      */
2081
2082         int i = 0;
2083     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [QueueFileArray objectEnumerator];
2084         id tempObject;
2085         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
2086         {
2087                 NSDictionary *thisQueueDict = tempObject;
2088                 if ([[thisQueueDict objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 0) // Completed
2089                 {
2090                         fCompletedCount++;      
2091                 }
2092                 if ([[thisQueueDict objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 1) // being encoded
2093                 {
2094                         fWorkingCount++;
2095             fEncodingQueueItem = i;     
2096                 }
2097         if ([[thisQueueDict objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 2) // pending          
2098         {
2099                         fPendingCount++;
2100                 }
2101         if ([[thisQueueDict objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 3) // cancelled                
2102         {
2103                         fCanceledCount++;
2104                 }
2105                 i++;
2106         }
2107
2108     /* Set the queue status field in the main window */
2109     NSMutableString * string;
2110     if (fPendingCount == 1)
2111     {
2112         string = [NSMutableString stringWithFormat: NSLocalizedString( @"%d encode pending in the queue", @"" ), fPendingCount];
2113     }
2114     else
2115     {
2116         string = [NSMutableString stringWithFormat: NSLocalizedString( @"%d encode(s) pending in the queue", @"" ), fPendingCount];
2117     }
2118     [fQueueStatus setStringValue:string];
2119 }
2120
2121 /* This method will set any item marked as encoding back to pending
2122  * currently used right after a queue reload
2123  */
2124 - (void) setQueueEncodingItemsAsPending
2125 {
2126     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [QueueFileArray objectEnumerator];
2127         id tempObject;
2128     NSMutableArray *tempArray;
2129     tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
2130     /* we look here to see if the preset is we move on to the next one */
2131     while ( tempObject = [enumerator nextObject] )  
2132     {
2133         /* If the queue item is marked as "encoding" (1)
2134          * then change its status back to pending (2) which effectively
2135          * puts it back into the queue to be encoded
2136          */
2137         if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 1)
2138         {
2139             [tempObject setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt: 2] forKey:@"Status"];
2140         }
2141         [tempArray addObject:tempObject];
2142     }
2143     
2144     [QueueFileArray setArray:tempArray];
2145     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2146 }
2147
2148
2149 /* This method will clear the queue of any encodes that are not still pending
2150  * this includes both successfully completed encodes as well as cancelled encodes */
2151 - (void) clearQueueEncodedItems
2152 {
2153     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [QueueFileArray objectEnumerator];
2154         id tempObject;
2155     NSMutableArray *tempArray;
2156     tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
2157     /* we look here to see if the preset is we move on to the next one */
2158     while ( tempObject = [enumerator nextObject] )  
2159     {
2160         /* If the queue item is either completed (0) or cancelled (3) from the
2161          * last session, then we put it in tempArray to be deleted from QueueFileArray.
2162          * NOTE: this means we retain pending (2) and also an item that is marked as
2163          * still encoding (1). If the queue has an item that is still marked as encoding
2164          * from a previous session, we can conlude that HB was either shutdown, or crashed
2165          * during the encodes so we keep it and tell the user in the "Load Queue Alert"
2166          */
2167         if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 0 || [[tempObject objectForKey:@"Status"] intValue] == 3)
2168         {
2169             [tempArray addObject:tempObject];
2170         }
2171     }
2172     
2173     [QueueFileArray removeObjectsInArray:tempArray];
2174     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2175 }
2176
2177 /* This method will clear the queue of all encodes. effectively creating an empty queue */
2178 - (void) clearQueueAllItems
2179 {
2180     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [QueueFileArray objectEnumerator];
2181         id tempObject;
2182     NSMutableArray *tempArray;
2183     tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
2184     /* we look here to see if the preset is we move on to the next one */
2185     while ( tempObject = [enumerator nextObject] )  
2186     {
2187         [tempArray addObject:tempObject];
2188     }
2189     
2190     [QueueFileArray removeObjectsInArray:tempArray];
2191     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2192 }
2193
2194 /* This method will duplicate prepareJob however into the
2195  * queue .plist instead of into the job structure so it can
2196  * be recalled later */
2197 - (NSDictionary *)createQueueFileItem
2198 {
2199     NSMutableDictionary *queueFileJob = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
2200     
2201        hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
2202     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list,
2203             [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
2204     hb_job_t * job = title->job;
2205     
2206     
2207     
2208     /* We use a number system to set the encode status of the queue item
2209      * 0 == already encoded
2210      * 1 == is being encoded
2211      * 2 == is yet to be encoded
2212      * 3 == cancelled
2213      */
2214     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:2] forKey:@"Status"];
2215     /* Source and Destination Information */
2216     
2217     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSString stringWithUTF8String: title->path] forKey:@"SourcePath"];
2218     [queueFileJob setObject:[fSrcDVD2Field stringValue] forKey:@"SourceName"];
2219     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:title->index] forKey:@"TitleNumber"];
2220     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcAnglePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1] forKey:@"TitleAngle"];
2221     
2222     /* Determine and set a variable to tell hb what start and stop times to use ... chapters vs seconds */
2223     if( [fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0 )
2224     {
2225         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"];    
2226     }
2227     else if ([fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 1)
2228     {
2229         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:1] forKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"];   
2230     }
2231     else if ([fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 2)
2232     {
2233         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:2] forKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"];
2234     }
2235     /* Chapter encode info */
2236     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1] forKey:@"ChapterStart"];
2237     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1] forKey:@"ChapterEnd"];
2238     /* Time (pts) encode info */
2239     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcTimeStartEncodingField intValue]] forKey:@"StartSeconds"];
2240     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcTimeEndEncodingField intValue] - [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField intValue]] forKey:@"StopSeconds"];
2241     /* Frame number encode info */
2242     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcFrameStartEncodingField intValue]] forKey:@"StartFrame"];
2243     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcFrameEndEncodingField intValue] - [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField intValue]] forKey:@"StopFrame"];
2244     
2245     
2246     /* The number of seek points equals the number of seconds announced in the title as that is our current granularity */
2247         int title_duration_seconds = (title->hours * 3600) + (title->minutes * 60) + (title->seconds);
2248     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:title_duration_seconds] forKey:@"SourceTotalSeconds"];
2249     
2250     [queueFileJob setObject:[fDstFile2Field stringValue] forKey:@"DestinationPath"];
2251     
2252     /* Lets get the preset info if there is any */
2253     [queueFileJob setObject:[fPresetSelectedDisplay stringValue] forKey:@"PresetName"];
2254     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] forKey:@"PresetIndexNum"];
2255     
2256     [queueFileJob setObject:[fDstFormatPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"FileFormat"];
2257     /* Chapter Markers*/
2258     /* If we have only one chapter or a title without chapters, set chapter markers to off */
2259     if ([fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] ==  [fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem])
2260     {
2261         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"ChapterMarkers"];
2262     }
2263     else
2264     {
2265         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fCreateChapterMarkers state]] forKey:@"ChapterMarkers"];
2266     }
2267         
2268     /* We need to get the list of chapter names to put into an array and store 
2269      * in our queue, so they can be reapplied in prepareJob when this queue
2270      * item comes up if Chapter Markers is set to on.
2271      */
2272      int i;
2273      NSMutableArray *ChapterNamesArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
2274      int chaptercount = hb_list_count( fTitle->list_chapter );
2275      for( i = 0; i < chaptercount; i++ )
2276     {
2277         hb_chapter_t *chapter = (hb_chapter_t *) hb_list_item( fTitle->list_chapter, i );
2278         if( chapter != NULL )
2279         {
2280           [ChapterNamesArray addObject:[NSString stringWithCString:chapter->title encoding:NSUTF8StringEncoding]];
2281         }
2282     }
2283     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSMutableArray arrayWithArray: ChapterNamesArray] forKey:@"ChapterNames"];
2284     [ChapterNamesArray autorelease];
2285     
2286     /* Allow Mpeg4 64 bit formatting +4GB file sizes */
2287         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4LargeFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4LargeFile"];
2288     /* Mux mp4 with http optimization */
2289     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4HttpOptimize"];
2290     /* Add iPod uuid atom */
2291     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4iPodFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4iPodCompatible"];
2292     
2293     /* Codecs */
2294         /* Video encoder */
2295         [queueFileJob setObject:[fVidEncoderPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"VideoEncoder"];
2296         /* x264 Option String */
2297         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAdvancedOptions optionsString] forKey:@"x264Option"];
2298
2299         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidQualityMatrix selectedRow]] forKey:@"VideoQualityType"];
2300         [queueFileJob setObject:[fVidTargetSizeField stringValue] forKey:@"VideoTargetSize"];
2301         [queueFileJob setObject:[fVidBitrateField stringValue] forKey:@"VideoAvgBitrate"];
2302         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fVidQualityRFField floatValue]] forKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"];
2303     /* Framerate */
2304     [queueFileJob setObject:[fVidRatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"VideoFramerate"];
2305     
2306         /* 2 Pass Encoding */
2307         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidTwoPassCheck state]] forKey:@"VideoTwoPass"];
2308         /* Turbo 2 pass Encoding fVidTurboPassCheck*/
2309         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidTurboPassCheck state]] forKey:@"VideoTurboTwoPass"];
2310     
2311         /* Picture Sizing */
2312         /* Use Max Picture settings for whatever the dvd is.*/
2313         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"UsesMaxPictureSettings"];
2314         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->width] forKey:@"PictureWidth"];
2315         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->height] forKey:@"PictureHeight"];
2316         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->keep_ratio] forKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"];
2317         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode] forKey:@"PicturePAR"];
2318     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->modulus] forKey:@"PictureModulus"];
2319     /* if we are custom anamorphic, store the exact storage, par and display dims */
2320     if (fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode == 3)
2321     {
2322         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->modulus] forKey:@"PicturePARModulus"];
2323         
2324         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->width] forKey:@"PicturePARStorageWidth"];
2325         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->height] forKey:@"PicturePARStorageHeight"];
2326         
2327         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->anamorphic.par_width] forKey:@"PicturePARPixelWidth"];
2328         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->anamorphic.par_height] forKey:@"PicturePARPixelHeight"];
2329         
2330         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:fTitle->job->anamorphic.dar_width] forKey:@"PicturePARDisplayWidth"];
2331         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:fTitle->job->anamorphic.dar_height] forKey:@"PicturePARDisplayHeight"];
2332
2333     }
2334     NSString * pictureSummary;
2335     pictureSummary = [fPictureSizeField stringValue];
2336     [queueFileJob setObject:pictureSummary forKey:@"PictureSizingSummary"];                 
2337     /* Set crop settings here */
2338         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController autoCrop]] forKey:@"PictureAutoCrop"];
2339     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[0]] forKey:@"PictureTopCrop"];
2340     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[1]] forKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"];
2341         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[2]] forKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"];
2342         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[3]] forKey:@"PictureRightCrop"];
2343     
2344     /* Picture Filters */
2345     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController detelecine]] forKey:@"PictureDetelecine"];
2346     [queueFileJob setObject:[fPictureController detelecineCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDetelecineCustom"];
2347     
2348     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController useDecomb]] forKey:@"PictureDecombDeinterlace"];
2349     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController decomb]] forKey:@"PictureDecomb"];
2350     [queueFileJob setObject:[fPictureController decombCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDecombCustom"];
2351     
2352     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController deinterlace]] forKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"];
2353     [queueFileJob setObject:[fPictureController deinterlaceCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDeinterlaceCustom"];
2354     
2355     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController denoise]] forKey:@"PictureDenoise"];
2356     [queueFileJob setObject:[fPictureController denoiseCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDenoiseCustom"];
2357     
2358     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSString stringWithFormat:@"%d",[fPictureController deblock]] forKey:@"PictureDeblock"];
2359     
2360     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController grayscale]] forKey:@"VideoGrayScale"];
2361     
2362     /*Audio*/
2363     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2364     {
2365         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"Audio1Track"];
2366         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudLang1PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio1TrackDescription"];
2367         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio1Encoder"];
2368         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio1Mixdown"];
2369         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio1Samplerate"];
2370         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio1Bitrate"];
2371         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack1DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"Audio1TrackDRCSlider"];
2372     }
2373     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2374     {
2375         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"Audio2Track"];
2376         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudLang2PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio2TrackDescription"];
2377         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio2Encoder"];
2378         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack2MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio2Mixdown"];
2379         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack2RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio2Samplerate"];
2380         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack2BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio2Bitrate"];
2381         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack2DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"Audio2TrackDRCSlider"];
2382     }
2383     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2384     {
2385         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"Audio3Track"];
2386         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudLang3PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio3TrackDescription"];
2387         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio3Encoder"];
2388         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack3MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio3Mixdown"];
2389         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack3RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio3Samplerate"];
2390         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack3BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio3Bitrate"];
2391         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack3DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"Audio3TrackDRCSlider"];
2392     }
2393     if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2394     {
2395         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"Audio4Track"];
2396         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudLang4PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio4TrackDescription"];
2397         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio4Encoder"];
2398         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack4MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio4Mixdown"];
2399         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack4RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio4Samplerate"];
2400         [queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack4BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Audio4Bitrate"];
2401         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack4DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"Audio4TrackDRCSlider"];
2402     }
2403     
2404         /* Subtitles*/
2405     NSMutableArray *subtitlesArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithArray:[fSubtitlesDelegate getSubtitleArray] copyItems:YES];
2406     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSArray arrayWithArray: subtitlesArray] forKey:@"SubtitleList"];
2407     [subtitlesArray autorelease];
2408
2409     /* Now we go ahead and set the "job->values in the plist for passing right to fQueueEncodeLibhb */
2410      
2411     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1] forKey:@"JobChapterStart"];
2412     
2413     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1] forKey:@"JobChapterEnd"];
2414     
2415     
2416     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fDstFormatPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobFileFormatMux"];
2417     
2418     /* Codecs */
2419         /* Video encoder */
2420         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobVideoEncoderVcodec"];
2421         
2422     /* Framerate */
2423     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidRatePopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"JobIndexVideoFramerate"];
2424     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:title->rate] forKey:@"JobVrate"];
2425     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:title->rate_base] forKey:@"JobVrateBase"];
2426         
2427     /* Picture Sizing */
2428         /* Use Max Picture settings for whatever the dvd is.*/
2429         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"UsesMaxPictureSettings"];
2430         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->width] forKey:@"PictureWidth"];
2431         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->height] forKey:@"PictureHeight"];
2432         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->keep_ratio] forKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"];
2433         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode] forKey:@"PicturePAR"];
2434     
2435     /* Set crop settings here */
2436         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController autoCrop]] forKey:@"PictureAutoCrop"];
2437     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[0]] forKey:@"PictureTopCrop"];
2438     [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[1]] forKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"];
2439         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[2]] forKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"];
2440         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[3]] forKey:@"PictureRightCrop"];
2441     
2442     
2443     /*Audio*/
2444     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2445     {
2446         //[queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"JobAudio1Encoder"];
2447         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio1Encoder"];
2448         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio1Mixdown"];
2449         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio1Samplerate"];
2450         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio1Bitrate"];
2451      }
2452     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2453     {
2454         //[queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"JobAudio2Encoder"];
2455         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio2Encoder"];
2456         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio2Mixdown"];
2457         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack2RatePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio2Samplerate"];
2458         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack2BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio2Bitrate"];
2459     }
2460     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2461     {
2462         //[queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"JobAudio3Encoder"];
2463         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio3Encoder"];
2464         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio3Mixdown"];
2465         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack3RatePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio3Samplerate"];
2466         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack3BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio3Bitrate"];
2467     }
2468     if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
2469     {
2470         //[queueFileJob setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"JobAudio4Encoder"];
2471         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio4Encoder"];
2472         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio4Mixdown"];
2473         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack4RatePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio4Samplerate"];
2474         [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[fAudTrack4BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag]] forKey:@"JobAudio4Bitrate"];
2475     }
2476
2477  
2478     /* we need to auto relase the queueFileJob and return it */
2479     [queueFileJob autorelease];
2480     return queueFileJob;
2481
2482 }
2483
2484 /* this is actually called from the queue controller to modify the queue array and return it back to the queue controller */
2485 - (void)moveObjectsInQueueArray:(NSMutableArray *)array fromIndexes:(NSIndexSet *)indexSet toIndex:(NSUInteger)insertIndex
2486 {
2487     NSUInteger index = [indexSet lastIndex];
2488     NSUInteger aboveInsertIndexCount = 0;
2489     
2490     
2491     NSUInteger removeIndex;
2492         
2493     if (index >= insertIndex)
2494     {
2495         removeIndex = index + aboveInsertIndexCount;
2496         aboveInsertIndexCount++;
2497     }
2498     else
2499     {
2500         removeIndex = index;
2501         insertIndex--;
2502     }
2503
2504     id object = [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:removeIndex] retain];
2505     [QueueFileArray removeObjectAtIndex:removeIndex];
2506     [QueueFileArray insertObject:object atIndex:insertIndex];
2507     [object release];
2508         
2509     index = [indexSet indexLessThanIndex:index];
2510
2511    /* We save all of the Queue data here 
2512     * and it also gets sent back to the queue controller*/
2513     [self saveQueueFileItem]; 
2514     
2515 }
2516
2517
2518 #pragma mark -
2519 #pragma mark Queue Job Processing
2520
2521 - (void) incrementQueueItemDone:(int) queueItemDoneIndexNum
2522 {
2523     int i = currentQueueEncodeIndex;
2524     [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:i] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Status"];
2525         
2526     /* We save all of the Queue data here */
2527     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2528         /* We Reload the New Table data for presets */
2529     //[fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
2530
2531     /* Since we have now marked a queue item as done
2532      * we can go ahead and increment currentQueueEncodeIndex 
2533      * so that if there is anything left in the queue we can
2534      * go ahead and move to the next item if we want to */
2535     currentQueueEncodeIndex++ ;
2536     [self writeToActivityLog: "incrementQueueItemDone currentQueueEncodeIndex is incremented to: %d", currentQueueEncodeIndex];
2537     int queueItems = [QueueFileArray count];
2538     /* If we still have more items in our queue, lets go to the next one */
2539     if (currentQueueEncodeIndex < queueItems)
2540     {
2541     [self writeToActivityLog: "incrementQueueItemDone currentQueueEncodeIndex is incremented to: %d", currentQueueEncodeIndex];
2542     [self performNewQueueScan:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SourcePath"] scanTitleNum:[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"]intValue]];
2543     }
2544     else
2545     {
2546         [self writeToActivityLog: "incrementQueueItemDone the %d item queue is complete", currentQueueEncodeIndex - 1];
2547     }
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Here we actually tell hb_scan to perform the source scan, using the path to source and title number*/
2551 - (void) performNewQueueScan:(NSString *) scanPath scanTitleNum: (int) scanTitleNum
2552 {
2553    /* Tell HB to output a new activity log file for this encode */
2554     [outputPanel startEncodeLog:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"]];
2555     
2556     
2557      /* use a bool to determine whether or not we can decrypt using vlc */
2558     BOOL cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
2559     /* set the bool so that showNewScan knows to apply the appropriate queue
2560     * settings as this is a queue rescan
2561     */
2562     //applyQueueToScan = YES;
2563     NSString *path = scanPath;
2564     HBDVDDetector *detector = [HBDVDDetector detectorForPath:path];
2565     
2566     if( [detector isVideoDVD] )
2567     {
2568         // The chosen path was actually on a DVD, so use the raw block
2569         // device path instead.
2570         path = [detector devicePath];
2571         [self writeToActivityLog: "trying to open a physical dvd at: %s", [scanPath UTF8String]];
2572
2573         /* lets check for vlc here to make sure we have a dylib available to use for decrypting */
2574         NSString *vlcPath = @"/Applications/VLC.app";
2575         NSFileManager * fileManager = [NSFileManager defaultManager];
2576             if ([fileManager fileExistsAtPath:vlcPath] == 0) 
2577             {
2578             /*vlc not found in /Applications so we set the bool to cancel scanning to 1 */
2579             cancelScanDecrypt = 1;
2580             [self writeToActivityLog: "VLC app not found for decrypting physical dvd"];
2581             int status;
2582             status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"HandBrake could not find VLC.",@"Please download and install VLC media player in your /Applications folder if you wish to read encrypted DVDs.", @"Get VLC", @"Cancel Scan", @"Attempt Scan Anyway");
2583             [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
2584             
2585             if (status == NSAlertDefaultReturn)
2586             {
2587                 /* User chose to go download vlc (as they rightfully should) so we send them to the vlc site */
2588                 [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL:[NSURL URLWithString:@"http://www.videolan.org/"]];
2589             }
2590             else if (status == NSAlertAlternateReturn)
2591             {
2592             /* User chose to cancel the scan */
2593             [self writeToActivityLog: "cannot open physical dvd , scan cancelled"];
2594             }
2595             else
2596             {
2597             /* User chose to override our warning and scan the physical dvd anyway, at their own peril. on an encrypted dvd this produces massive log files and fails */
2598             cancelScanDecrypt = 0;
2599             [self writeToActivityLog: "user overrode vlc warning -trying to open physical dvd without decryption"];
2600             }
2601
2602         }
2603         else
2604         {
2605             /* VLC was found in /Applications so all is well, we can carry on using vlc's libdvdcss.dylib for decrypting if needed */
2606             [self writeToActivityLog: "VLC app found for decrypting physical dvd"];
2607         }
2608     }
2609
2610     if (cancelScanDecrypt == 0)
2611     {
2612         /* we actually pass the scan off to libhb here */
2613         /* If there is no title number passed to scan, we use "0"
2614          * which causes the default behavior of a full source scan
2615          */
2616         if (!scanTitleNum)
2617         {
2618             scanTitleNum = 0;
2619         }
2620         if (scanTitleNum > 0)
2621         {
2622             [self writeToActivityLog: "scanning specifically for title: %d", scanTitleNum];
2623         }
2624         
2625         [self writeToActivityLog: "performNewQueueScan currentQueueEncodeIndex is: %d", currentQueueEncodeIndex];
2626         /* We use our advance pref to determine how many previews to scan */
2627         int hb_num_previews = [[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey:@"PreviewsNumber"] intValue];
2628         hb_scan( fQueueEncodeLibhb, [path UTF8String], scanTitleNum, hb_num_previews, 0 );
2629     }
2630 }
2631
2632 /* This assumes that we have re-scanned and loaded up a new queue item to send to libhb as fQueueEncodeLibhb */
2633 - (void) processNewQueueEncode
2634 {
2635     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
2636     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list,0 ); // is always zero since now its a single title scan
2637     hb_job_t * job = title->job;
2638     
2639     if( !hb_list_count( list ) )
2640     {
2641         [self writeToActivityLog: "processNewQueueEncode WARNING nothing found in the title list"];
2642     }
2643     
2644     NSMutableDictionary * queueToApply = [QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex];
2645     [self writeToActivityLog: "Preset: %s", [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PresetName"] UTF8String]];
2646     [self writeToActivityLog: "processNewQueueEncode number of passes expected is: %d", ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTwoPass"] intValue] + 1)];
2647     job->file = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"] UTF8String];
2648     //[self writeToActivityLog: "processNewQueueEncode sending to prepareJob"];
2649     [self prepareJob];
2650     
2651     /*
2652      * If scanning we need to do some extra setup of the job.
2653      */
2654     if( job->indepth_scan == 1 )
2655     {
2656         char *x264opts_tmp;
2657         
2658         /*
2659          * When subtitle scan is enabled do a fast pre-scan job
2660          * which will determine which subtitles to enable, if any.
2661          */
2662         job->pass = -1;
2663         x264opts_tmp = job->x264opts;
2664         
2665         job->x264opts = NULL;
2666         
2667         job->indepth_scan = 1;  
2668
2669         
2670         /*
2671          * Add the pre-scan job
2672          */
2673         hb_add( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
2674         job->x264opts = x264opts_tmp;
2675     }
2676
2677     
2678     if( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTwoPass"] intValue] == 1 )
2679     {
2680         job->indepth_scan = 0;
2681         
2682
2683         
2684         job->pass = 1;
2685         
2686         hb_add( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
2687         
2688         job->pass = 2;
2689         
2690         job->x264opts = (char *)calloc(1024, 1); /* Fixme, this just leaks */  
2691         strcpy(job->x264opts, [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"x264Option"] UTF8String]);
2692         
2693         hb_add( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
2694         
2695     }
2696     else
2697     {
2698         job->indepth_scan = 0;
2699         job->pass = 0;
2700         
2701         hb_add( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
2702     }
2703         
2704     NSString *destinationDirectory = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
2705         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:destinationDirectory forKey:@"LastDestinationDirectory"];
2706         /* Lets mark our new encode as 1 or "Encoding" */
2707     [queueToApply setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:1] forKey:@"Status"];
2708     [self saveQueueFileItem];
2709     
2710     /* we need to clean up the subtitle tracks after the job(s) have been set  */
2711     int num_subtitle_tracks = hb_list_count(job->list_subtitle);
2712     int ii;
2713     for(ii = 0; ii < num_subtitle_tracks; ii++)
2714     {
2715         hb_subtitle_t * subtitle;
2716         subtitle = (hb_subtitle_t *)hb_list_item(job->list_subtitle, 0);
2717         
2718
2719         hb_list_rem(job->list_subtitle, subtitle);
2720         free(subtitle);
2721     }
2722     
2723     
2724     /* We should be all setup so let 'er rip */   
2725     [self doRip];
2726 }
2727
2728
2729
2730 #pragma mark -
2731 #pragma mark Queue Item Editing
2732
2733 /* Rescans the chosen queue item back into the main window */
2734 - (void)rescanQueueItemToMainWindow:(NSString *) scanPath scanTitleNum: (int) scanTitleNum selectedQueueItem: (int) selectedQueueItem
2735 {
2736     fqueueEditRescanItemNum = selectedQueueItem;
2737     [self writeToActivityLog: "rescanQueueItemToMainWindow: Re-scanning queue item at index:%d",fqueueEditRescanItemNum];
2738     applyQueueToScan = YES;
2739     /* Set the browsedSourceDisplayName for showNewScan */
2740     browsedSourceDisplayName = [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:fqueueEditRescanItemNum] objectForKey:@"SourceName"];
2741     [self performScan:scanPath scanTitleNum:scanTitleNum];
2742 }
2743
2744
2745 /* We use this method after a queue item rescan for edit.
2746  * it largely mirrors -selectPreset in terms of structure.
2747  * Assumes that a queue item has been reloaded into the main window.
2748  */
2749 - (IBAction)applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow:(id)sender
2750 {
2751     NSMutableDictionary * queueToApply = [QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:fqueueEditRescanItemNum];
2752     hb_job_t * job = fTitle->job;
2753     if (queueToApply)
2754     {
2755         [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: queue item found"];
2756     }
2757     /* Set title number and chapters */
2758     /* since the queue only scans a single title, its already been selected in showNewScan
2759        so do not try to reset it here. However if we do decide to do full source scans on
2760        a queue edit rescan, we would need it. So leaving in for now but commenting out. */
2761     //[fSrcTitlePopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"] intValue] - 1];
2762     
2763     [fSrcChapterStartPopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"ChapterStart"] intValue] - 1];
2764     [fSrcChapterEndPopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"ChapterEnd"] intValue] - 1];
2765     
2766     /* File Format */
2767     [fDstFormatPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"FileFormat"]];
2768     [self formatPopUpChanged:nil];
2769     
2770     /* Chapter Markers*/
2771     [fCreateChapterMarkers setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"ChapterMarkers"] intValue]];
2772     /* Allow Mpeg4 64 bit formatting +4GB file sizes */
2773     [fDstMp4LargeFileCheck setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4LargeFile"] intValue]];
2774     /* Mux mp4 with http optimization */
2775     [fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4HttpOptimize"] intValue]];
2776     
2777     /* Video encoder */
2778     /* We set the advanced opt string here if applicable*/
2779     [fVidEncoderPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoEncoder"]];
2780     [fAdvancedOptions setOptions:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"x264Option"]];
2781     
2782     /* Lets run through the following functions to get variables set there */
2783     [self videoEncoderPopUpChanged:nil];
2784     /* Set the state of ipod compatible with Mp4iPodCompatible. Only for x264*/
2785     [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4iPodCompatible"] intValue]];
2786     [self calculateBitrate:nil];
2787     
2788     /* Video quality */
2789     [fVidQualityMatrix selectCellAtRow:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualityType"] intValue] column:0];
2790     
2791     [fVidTargetSizeField setStringValue:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTargetSize"]];
2792     [fVidBitrateField setStringValue:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoAvgBitrate"]];
2793     /* Since we are now using RF Values for the slider, we detect if the preset uses an old quality float.
2794      * So, check to see if the quality value is less than 1.0 which should indicate the old ".062" type
2795      * quality preset. Caveat: in the case of x264, where the RF scale starts at 0, it would misinterpret
2796      * a preset that uses 0.0 - 0.99 for RF as an old style preset. Not sure how to get around that one yet,
2797      * though it should be a corner case since it would pretty much be a preset for lossless encoding. */
2798     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue] < 1.0)
2799     {
2800         /* For the quality slider we need to convert the old percent's to the new rf scales */
2801         float rf =  (([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider minValue]) * [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]);
2802         [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:rf];
2803         
2804     }
2805     else
2806     {
2807         /* Since theora's qp value goes up from left to right, we can just set the slider float value */
2808         if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_THEORA)
2809         {
2810             [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]];
2811         }
2812         else
2813         {
2814             /* since ffmpeg and x264 use an "inverted" slider (lower qp/rf values indicate a higher quality) we invert the value on the slider */
2815             [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] + [fVidQualitySlider minValue]) - [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]];
2816         }
2817     }
2818     
2819     [self videoMatrixChanged:nil];
2820     [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: video matrix changed"];    
2821     /* Video framerate */
2822     /* For video preset video framerate, we want to make sure that Same as source does not conflict with the
2823      detected framerate in the fVidRatePopUp so we use index 0*/
2824     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoFramerate"] isEqualToString:@"Same as source"])
2825     {
2826         [fVidRatePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
2827     }
2828     else
2829     {
2830         [fVidRatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoFramerate"]];
2831     }
2832     
2833     /* 2 Pass Encoding */
2834     [fVidTwoPassCheck setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTwoPass"] intValue]];
2835     [self twoPassCheckboxChanged:nil];
2836     /* Turbo 1st pass for 2 Pass Encoding */
2837     [fVidTurboPassCheck setState:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTurboTwoPass"] intValue]];
2838     
2839     /*Audio*/
2840     
2841     
2842     /* Now lets add our new tracks to the audio list here */
2843     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] intValue] > 0)
2844     {
2845         [fAudLang1PopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] intValue]];
2846         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang1PopUp];
2847         [fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Encoder"]];
2848         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack1CodecPopUp];
2849         
2850         [fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Mixdown"]];
2851         
2852         [fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Samplerate"]];
2853         [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Bitrate"]];
2854         
2855         [fAudTrack1DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
2856         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack1DrcSlider];
2857     }
2858     else
2859     {
2860         [fAudLang1PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
2861         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang1PopUp];
2862     }
2863     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] intValue] > 0)
2864     {
2865         [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] intValue]];
2866         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
2867         [fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Encoder"]];
2868         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack2CodecPopUp];
2869         
2870         [fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Mixdown"]];
2871         
2872         [fAudTrack2RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Samplerate"]];
2873         [fAudTrack2BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Bitrate"]];
2874         
2875         [fAudTrack2DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
2876         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack2DrcSlider];
2877     }
2878     else
2879     {
2880         [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
2881         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
2882     }
2883     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] intValue] > 0)
2884     {
2885         [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] intValue]];
2886         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
2887         [fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Encoder"]];
2888         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack3CodecPopUp];
2889         
2890         [fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Mixdown"]];
2891         
2892         [fAudTrack3RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Samplerate"]];
2893         [fAudTrack3BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Bitrate"]];
2894         
2895         [fAudTrack3DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
2896         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack3DrcSlider];
2897     }
2898     else
2899     {
2900         [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
2901         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
2902     }
2903     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] intValue] > 0)
2904     {
2905         [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] intValue]];
2906         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
2907         [fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Encoder"]];
2908         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack4CodecPopUp];
2909         
2910         [fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Mixdown"]];
2911         
2912         [fAudTrack4RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Samplerate"]];
2913         [fAudTrack4BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Bitrate"]];
2914         
2915         [fAudTrack4DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
2916         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack4DrcSlider];
2917     }
2918     else
2919     {
2920         [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
2921         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
2922     }
2923     
2924     [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: audio set up"];
2925     /*Subtitles*/
2926     /* Crashy crashy right now, working on it */
2927     [fSubtitlesDelegate setNewSubtitles:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"SubtitleList"]];
2928     [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];  
2929     /* Picture Settings */
2930     
2931     /* If Cropping is set to custom, then recall all four crop values from
2932      when the preset was created and apply them */
2933     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureAutoCrop"]  intValue] == 0)
2934     {
2935         [fPictureController setAutoCrop:NO];
2936         
2937         /* Here we use the custom crop values saved at the time the preset was saved */
2938         job->crop[0] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureTopCrop"]  intValue];
2939         job->crop[1] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"]  intValue];
2940         job->crop[2] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"]  intValue];
2941         job->crop[3] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureRightCrop"]  intValue];
2942         
2943     }
2944     else /* if auto crop has been saved in preset, set to auto and use post scan auto crop */
2945     {
2946         [fPictureController setAutoCrop:YES];
2947         /* Here we use the auto crop values determined right after scan */
2948         job->crop[0] = AutoCropTop;
2949         job->crop[1] = AutoCropBottom;
2950         job->crop[2] = AutoCropLeft;
2951         job->crop[3] = AutoCropRight;
2952         
2953     }
2954     
2955     job->modulus = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureModulus"]  intValue];
2956     
2957     /* we check to make sure the presets width/height does not exceed the sources width/height */
2958     if (fTitle->width < [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureWidth"]  intValue] || fTitle->height < [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureHeight"]  intValue])
2959     {
2960         /* if so, then we use the sources height and width to avoid scaling up */
2961         //job->width = fTitle->width;
2962         //job->height = fTitle->height;
2963         [self revertPictureSizeToMax:nil];
2964     }
2965     else // source width/height is >= the preset height/width
2966     {
2967         /* we can go ahead and use the presets values for height and width */
2968         job->width = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureWidth"]  intValue];
2969         job->height = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureHeight"]  intValue];
2970     }
2971     job->keep_ratio = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"]  intValue];
2972     if (job->keep_ratio == 1)
2973     {
2974         hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_WIDTH );
2975         if( job->height > fTitle->height )
2976         {
2977             job->height = fTitle->height;
2978             hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_HEIGHT );
2979         }
2980     }
2981     job->anamorphic.mode = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePAR"]  intValue];
2982     job->modulus = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureModulus"]  intValue];
2983     
2984     [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: picture sizing set up"];
2985     
2986     
2987     /* Filters */
2988     
2989     /* We only allow *either* Decomb or Deinterlace. So check for the PictureDecombDeinterlace key.
2990      * also, older presets may not have this key, in which case we also check to see if that preset had  PictureDecomb
2991      * specified, in which case we use decomb and ignore any possible Deinterlace settings as using both was less than
2992      * sane.
2993      */
2994     [fPictureController setUseDecomb:1];
2995     [fPictureController setDecomb:0];
2996     [fPictureController setDeinterlace:0];
2997     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecombDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1 || [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] > 0)
2998     {
2999         /* we are using decomb */
3000         /* Decomb */
3001         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] > 0)
3002         {
3003             [fPictureController setDecomb:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue]];
3004             
3005             /* if we are using "Custom" in the decomb setting, also set the custom string*/
3006             if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] == 1)
3007             {
3008                 [fPictureController setDecombCustomString:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecombCustom"]];    
3009             }
3010         }
3011     }
3012     else
3013     {
3014         /* We are using Deinterlace */
3015         /* Deinterlace */
3016         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] > 0)
3017         {
3018             [fPictureController setUseDecomb:0];
3019             [fPictureController setDeinterlace:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue]];
3020             /* if we are using "Custom" in the deinterlace setting, also set the custom string*/
3021             if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1)
3022             {
3023                 [fPictureController setDeinterlaceCustomString:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlaceCustom"]];    
3024             }
3025         }
3026     }
3027     
3028     
3029     /* Detelecine */
3030     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] > 0)
3031     {
3032         [fPictureController setDetelecine:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue]];
3033         /* if we are using "Custom" in the detelecine setting, also set the custom string*/
3034         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] == 1)
3035         {
3036             [fPictureController setDetelecineCustomString:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecineCustom"]];    
3037         }
3038     }
3039     else
3040     {
3041         [fPictureController setDetelecine:0];
3042     }
3043     
3044     /* Denoise */
3045     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] > 0)
3046     {
3047         [fPictureController setDenoise:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue]];
3048         /* if we are using "Custom" in the denoise setting, also set the custom string*/
3049         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 1)
3050         {
3051             [fPictureController setDenoiseCustomString:[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoiseCustom"]];    
3052         }
3053     }
3054     else
3055     {
3056         [fPictureController setDenoise:0];
3057     }   
3058     
3059     /* Deblock */
3060     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] intValue] == 1)
3061     {
3062         /* if its a one, then its the old on/off deblock, set on to 5*/
3063         [fPictureController setDeblock:5];
3064     }
3065     else
3066     {
3067         /* use the settings intValue */
3068         [fPictureController setDeblock:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] intValue]];
3069     }
3070     
3071     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoGrayScale"] intValue] == 1)
3072     {
3073         [fPictureController setGrayscale:1];
3074     }
3075     else
3076     {
3077         [fPictureController setGrayscale:0];
3078     }
3079     
3080     /* we call SetTitle: in fPictureController so we get an instant update in the Picture Settings window */
3081     [fPictureController SetTitle:fTitle];
3082     [self calculatePictureSizing:nil];
3083     
3084     [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: picture filters set up"];
3085     /* somehow we need to figure out a way to tie the queue item to a preset if it used one */
3086     //[queueFileJob setObject:[fPresetSelectedDisplay stringValue] forKey:@"PresetName"];
3087     //    [queueFileJob setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] forKey:@"PresetIndexNum"];
3088     if ([queueToApply objectForKey:@"PresetIndexNum"]) // This item used a preset so insert that info
3089         {
3090                 /* Deselect the currently selected Preset if there is one*/
3091         //[fPresetsOutlineView selectRowIndexes:[NSIndexSet indexSetWithIndex:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PresetIndexNum"] intValue]] byExtendingSelection:NO];
3092         //[self selectPreset:nil];
3093                 
3094         //[fPresetsOutlineView selectRow:[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PresetIndexNum"] intValue]];
3095                 /* Change UI to show "Custom" settings are being used */
3096                 //[fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue: [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PresetName"] stringValue]];
3097         
3098                 curUserPresetChosenNum = nil;
3099         }
3100     else
3101     {
3102         /* Deselect the currently selected Preset if there is one*/
3103                 [fPresetsOutlineView deselectRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
3104                 /* Change UI to show "Custom" settings are being used */
3105                 [fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue: @"Custom"];
3106         
3107                 //curUserPresetChosenNum = nil;
3108     }
3109     
3110     /* We need to set this bool back to NO, in case the user wants to do a scan */
3111     //applyQueueToScan = NO;
3112     
3113     /* Not that source is loaded and settings applied, delete the queue item from the queue */
3114     [self writeToActivityLog: "applyQueueSettingsToMainWindow: deleting queue item:%d",fqueueEditRescanItemNum];
3115     [self removeQueueFileItem:fqueueEditRescanItemNum];
3116 }
3117
3118
3119
3120 #pragma mark -
3121 #pragma mark Live Preview
3122 /* Note,this is much like prepareJob, but directly sets the job vars so Picture Preview
3123  * can encode to its temp preview directory and playback. This is *not* used for any actual user
3124  * encodes
3125  */
3126 - (void) prepareJobForPreview
3127 {
3128     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
3129     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list,
3130             [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
3131     hb_job_t * job = title->job;
3132     hb_audio_config_t * audio;
3133     /* set job->angle for libdvdnav */
3134     job->angle = [fSrcAnglePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1;
3135     /* Chapter selection */
3136     job->chapter_start = [fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1;
3137     job->chapter_end   = [fSrcChapterEndPopUp   indexOfSelectedItem] + 1;
3138         
3139     /* Format (Muxer) and Video Encoder */
3140     job->mux = [[fDstFormatPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3141     job->vcodec = [[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3142
3143     job->chapter_markers = 0;
3144     
3145         if( job->vcodec & HB_VCODEC_X264 )
3146     {
3147                 
3148                 /* Below Sends x264 options to the core library if x264 is selected*/
3149                 /* Lets use this as per Nyx, Thanks Nyx!*/
3150                 job->x264opts = (char *)calloc(1024, 1); /* Fixme, this just leaks */
3151                 /* For previews we ignore the turbo option for the first pass of two since we only use 1 pass */
3152                 strcpy(job->x264opts, [[fAdvancedOptions optionsString] UTF8String]);
3153
3154         
3155     }
3156
3157     /* Video settings */
3158    /* Set vfr to 0 as it's only on if using same as source in the framerate popup
3159      * and detelecine is on, so we handle that in the logic below
3160      */
3161     job->vfr = 0;
3162     if( [fVidRatePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0 )
3163     {
3164         /* a specific framerate has been chosen */
3165         job->vrate      = 27000000;
3166         job->vrate_base = hb_video_rates[[fVidRatePopUp indexOfSelectedItem]-1].rate;
3167         /* We are not same as source so we set job->cfr to 1 
3168          * to enable constant frame rate since user has specified
3169          * a specific framerate*/
3170         job->cfr = 1;
3171     }
3172     else
3173     {
3174         /* We are same as source (variable) */
3175         job->vrate      = title->rate;
3176         job->vrate_base = title->rate_base;
3177         /* We are same as source so we set job->cfr to 0 
3178          * to enable true same as source framerate */
3179         job->cfr = 0;
3180         /* If we are same as source and we have detelecine on, we need to turn on
3181          * job->vfr
3182          */
3183         if ([fPictureController detelecine] == 1)
3184         {
3185             job->vfr = 1;
3186         }
3187     }
3188
3189     switch( [fVidQualityMatrix selectedRow] )
3190     {
3191         case 0:
3192             /* Target size.
3193                Bitrate should already have been calculated and displayed
3194                in fVidBitrateField, so let's just use it */
3195         case 1:
3196             job->vquality = -1.0;
3197             job->vbitrate = [fVidBitrateField intValue];
3198             break;
3199         case 2:
3200             job->vquality = [fVidQualityRFField floatValue];
3201             job->vbitrate = 0;
3202             break;
3203     }
3204
3205     /* Subtitle settings */
3206     NSMutableArray *subtitlesArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithArray:[fSubtitlesDelegate getSubtitleArray] copyItems:YES];
3207     
3208     
3209 int subtitle = nil;
3210 int force;
3211 int burned;
3212 int def;
3213 bool one_burned = FALSE;
3214
3215     int i = 0;
3216     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [subtitlesArray objectEnumerator];
3217     id tempObject;
3218     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
3219     {
3220         
3221         subtitle = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackNum"] intValue];
3222         force = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackForced"] intValue];
3223         burned = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackBurned"] intValue];
3224         def = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackDefault"] intValue];
3225         
3226         /* since the subtitleSourceTrackNum 0 is "None" in our array of the subtitle popups,
3227          * we want to ignore it for display as well as encoding.
3228          */
3229         if (subtitle > 0)
3230         {
3231             /* if i is 0, then we are in the first item of the subtitles which we need to 
3232              * check for the "Foreign Audio Search" which would be subtitleSourceTrackNum of 1
3233              * bearing in mind that for all tracks subtitleSourceTrackNum of 0 is None.
3234              */
3235             
3236             /* if we are on the first track and using "Foreign Audio Search" */ 
3237             if (i == 0 && subtitle == 1)
3238             {
3239                 /* NOTE: Currently foreign language search is borked for preview.
3240                  * Commented out but left in for initial commit. */
3241                 
3242                 
3243                 [self writeToActivityLog: "Foreign Language Search: %d", 1];
3244                 
3245                 job->indepth_scan = 1;
3246                 if (burned == 1 || job->mux != HB_MUX_MP4)
3247                 {
3248                     if (burned != 1 && job->mux == HB_MUX_MKV)
3249                     {
3250                         job->select_subtitle_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3251                     }
3252                     else
3253                     {
3254                         job->select_subtitle_config.dest = RENDERSUB;
3255                     }
3256                     
3257                     job->select_subtitle_config.force = force;
3258                     job->select_subtitle_config.default_track = def;
3259                     
3260                 }
3261                 
3262                 
3263             }
3264             else
3265             {
3266                 
3267                 /* for the actual source tracks, we must subtract the non source entries so 
3268                  * that the menu index matches the source subtitle_list index for convenience */
3269                 if (i == 0)
3270                 {
3271                     /* for the first track, the source tracks start at menu index 2 ( None is 0,
3272                      * Foreign Language Search is 1) so subtract 2 */
3273                     subtitle = subtitle - 2;
3274                 }
3275                 else
3276                 {
3277                     /* for all other tracks, the source tracks start at menu index 1 (None is 0)
3278                      * so subtract 1. */
3279                     
3280                     subtitle = subtitle - 1;
3281                 }
3282                 
3283                 /* We are setting a source subtitle so access the source subtitle info */  
3284                 hb_subtitle_t * subt;
3285                 
3286                 subt = (hb_subtitle_t *)hb_list_item(title->list_subtitle, subtitle);
3287                 
3288                 /* if we are getting the subtitles from an external srt file */
3289                 if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackType"] isEqualToString:@"SRT"])
3290                 {
3291                     hb_subtitle_config_t sub_config;
3292                     
3293                     sub_config.offset = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtOffset"] intValue];
3294                     
3295                     /* we need to srncpy file path and char code */
3296                     strncpy(sub_config.src_filename, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceSrtFilePath"] UTF8String], 128);
3297                     strncpy(sub_config.src_codeset, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtCharCode"] UTF8String], 40);
3298                     
3299                     sub_config.force = 0;
3300                     sub_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3301                     sub_config.default_track = def;
3302                     
3303                     hb_srt_add( job, &sub_config, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtLanguageIso3"] UTF8String]);
3304                 }
3305                 
3306                 if (subt != NULL)
3307                 {
3308                     hb_subtitle_config_t sub_config = subt->config;
3309                     
3310                     if (!burned && job->mux == HB_MUX_MKV && 
3311                         subt->format == PICTURESUB)
3312                     {
3313                         sub_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3314                     }
3315                     else if (!burned && job->mux == HB_MUX_MP4 && 
3316                              subt->format == PICTURESUB)
3317                     {
3318                         // Skip any non-burned vobsubs when output is mp4
3319                         continue;
3320                     }
3321                     else if ( burned && subt->format == PICTURESUB )
3322                     {
3323                         // Only allow one subtitle to be burned into the video
3324                         if (one_burned)
3325                             continue;
3326                         one_burned = TRUE;
3327                     }
3328                     sub_config.force = force;
3329                     sub_config.default_track = def;
3330                     hb_subtitle_add( job, &sub_config, subtitle );
3331                 }   
3332                 
3333             }
3334         }
3335         i++;
3336     }
3337    
3338     
3339     
3340 [subtitlesArray autorelease];    
3341     
3342     
3343     /* Audio tracks and mixdowns */
3344     /* Lets make sure there arent any erroneous audio tracks in the job list, so lets make sure its empty*/
3345     int audiotrack_count = hb_list_count(job->list_audio);
3346     for( int i = 0; i < audiotrack_count;i++)
3347     {
3348         hb_audio_t * temp_audio = (hb_audio_t*) hb_list_item( job->list_audio, 0 );
3349         hb_list_rem(job->list_audio, temp_audio);
3350     }
3351     /* Now lets add our new tracks to the audio list here */
3352     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
3353     {
3354         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3355         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3356         audio->in.track = [fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3357         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3358         audio->out.track = [fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3359         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3360         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3361         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3362         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3363         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack1DrcField floatValue];
3364         
3365         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3366         free(audio);
3367     }  
3368     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
3369     {
3370         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3371         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3372         audio->in.track = [fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3373         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3374         audio->out.track = [fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3375         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3376         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3377         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack2BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3378         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack2RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3379         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack2DrcField floatValue];
3380         
3381         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3382         free(audio);
3383         
3384     }
3385     
3386     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
3387     {
3388         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3389         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3390         audio->in.track = [fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3391         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3392         audio->out.track = [fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3393         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3394         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3395         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack3BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3396         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack3RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3397         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack3DrcField floatValue];
3398         
3399         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3400         free(audio);
3401         
3402     }
3403
3404     if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
3405     {
3406         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3407         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3408         audio->in.track = [fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3409         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3410         audio->out.track = [fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
3411         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3412         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
3413         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack4BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3414         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack4RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
3415         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack4DrcField floatValue];
3416         
3417         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3418         free(audio);
3419         
3420     }
3421
3422     
3423     
3424     /* Filters */
3425     
3426     /* Though Grayscale is not really a filter, per se
3427      * we put it here since its in the filters panel
3428      */
3429      
3430     if ([fPictureController grayscale])
3431     {
3432         job->grayscale = 1;
3433     }
3434     else
3435     {
3436         job->grayscale = 0;
3437     }
3438     
3439     /* Initialize the filters list */
3440     job->filters = hb_list_init();
3441     
3442     /* Now lets call the filters if applicable.
3443     * The order of the filters is critical
3444     */
3445     
3446         /* Detelecine */
3447     if ([fPictureController detelecine] == 1)
3448     {
3449         /* use a custom detelecine string */
3450         hb_filter_detelecine.settings = (char *) [[fPictureController detelecineCustomString] UTF8String];
3451         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_detelecine );
3452     }
3453     if ([fPictureController detelecine] == 2)
3454     {
3455         /* Default */
3456         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_detelecine );
3457     }
3458     
3459     
3460     
3461     if ([fPictureController useDecomb] == 1)
3462     {
3463         /* Decomb */
3464         /* we add the custom string if present */
3465         if ([fPictureController decomb] == 1)
3466         {
3467             /* use a custom decomb string */
3468             hb_filter_decomb.settings = (char *) [[fPictureController decombCustomString] UTF8String];
3469             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_decomb );
3470         }
3471         if ([fPictureController decomb] == 2)
3472         {
3473             /* Run old deinterlacer fd by default */
3474             //hb_filter_decomb.settings = (char *) [[fPicSettingDecomb stringValue] UTF8String];
3475             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_decomb );
3476         }
3477     }
3478     else
3479     {
3480         
3481         /* Deinterlace */
3482         if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 1)
3483         {
3484             /* we add the custom string if present */
3485             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = (char *) [[fPictureController deinterlaceCustomString] UTF8String];
3486             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
3487         }
3488         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 2)
3489         {
3490             /* Run old deinterlacer fd by default */
3491             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "-1"; 
3492             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );
3493         }
3494         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 3)
3495         {
3496             /* Yadif mode 0 (without spatial deinterlacing.) */
3497             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "2"; 
3498             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
3499         }
3500         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 4)
3501         {
3502             /* Yadif (with spatial deinterlacing) */
3503             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "0"; 
3504             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
3505         }
3506         
3507         }
3508     
3509     /* Denoise */
3510         if ([fPictureController denoise] == 1) // custom in popup
3511         {
3512                 /* we add the custom string if present */
3513         hb_filter_denoise.settings = (char *) [[fPictureController denoiseCustomString] UTF8String]; 
3514         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
3515         }
3516     else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 2) // Weak in popup
3517         {
3518                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "2:1:2:3"; 
3519         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
3520         }
3521         else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 3) // Medium in popup
3522         {
3523                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "3:2:2:3"; 
3524         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
3525         }
3526         else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 4) // Strong in popup
3527         {
3528                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "7:7:5:5"; 
3529         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
3530         }
3531     
3532     
3533     /* Deblock  (uses pp7 default) */
3534     /* NOTE: even though there is a valid deblock setting of 0 for the filter, for 
3535      * the macgui's purposes a value of 0 actually means to not even use the filter
3536      * current hb_filter_deblock.settings valid ranges are from 5 - 15 
3537      */
3538     if ([fPictureController deblock] != 0)
3539     {
3540         NSString *deblockStringValue = [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d",[fPictureController deblock]];
3541         hb_filter_deblock.settings = (char *) [deblockStringValue UTF8String];
3542         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deblock );
3543     }
3544
3545 }
3546
3547
3548 #pragma mark -
3549 #pragma mark Job Handling
3550
3551
3552 - (void) prepareJob
3553 {
3554     
3555     NSMutableDictionary * queueToApply = [QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex];
3556     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
3557     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list,0 ); // is always zero since now its a single title scan
3558     hb_job_t * job = title->job;
3559     hb_audio_config_t * audio;
3560     /* Title Angle for dvdnav */
3561     job->angle = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"TitleAngle"] intValue];
3562     
3563     if([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"] intValue] == 0)
3564     {
3565         /* Chapter selection */
3566         [self writeToActivityLog: "Start / Stop set to chapters"];
3567         job->chapter_start = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobChapterStart"] intValue];
3568         job->chapter_end   = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobChapterEnd"] intValue];
3569     }
3570     else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"] intValue] == 1)
3571     {
3572         /* we are pts based start / stop */
3573         [self writeToActivityLog: "Start / Stop set to seconds ..."];
3574         
3575         /* Point A to Point B. Time to time in seconds.*/
3576         /* get the start seconds from the start seconds field */
3577         int start_seconds = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"StartSeconds"] intValue];
3578         job->pts_to_start = start_seconds * 90000LL;
3579         /* Stop seconds is actually the duration of encode, so subtract the end seconds from the start seconds */
3580         int stop_seconds = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"StopSeconds"] intValue];
3581         job->pts_to_stop = stop_seconds * 90000LL;
3582         
3583     }
3584     else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"fEncodeStartStop"] intValue] == 2)
3585     {
3586         /* we are frame based start / stop */
3587         [self writeToActivityLog: "Start / Stop set to frames ..."];
3588         
3589         /* Point A to Point B. Frame to frame */
3590         /* get the start frame from the start frame field */
3591         int start_frame = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"StartFrame"] intValue];
3592         job->frame_to_start = start_frame;
3593         /* get the frame to stop on from the end frame field */
3594         int stop_frame = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"StopFrame"] intValue];
3595         job->frame_to_stop = stop_frame;
3596         
3597     }
3598
3599         
3600         
3601     
3602     /* Format (Muxer) and Video Encoder */
3603     job->mux = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobFileFormatMux"] intValue];
3604     job->vcodec = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobVideoEncoderVcodec"] intValue];
3605     
3606     
3607     /* If mpeg-4, then set mpeg-4 specific options like chapters and > 4gb file sizes */
3608     if( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4LargeFile"] intValue] == 1)
3609     {
3610         job->largeFileSize = 1;
3611     }
3612     else
3613     {
3614         job->largeFileSize = 0;
3615     }
3616     /* We set http optimized mp4 here */
3617     if( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4HttpOptimize"] intValue] == 1 )
3618     {
3619         job->mp4_optimize = 1;
3620     }
3621     else
3622     {
3623         job->mp4_optimize = 0;
3624     }
3625
3626         
3627     /* We set the chapter marker extraction here based on the format being
3628      mpeg4 or mkv and the checkbox being checked */
3629     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"ChapterMarkers"] intValue] == 1)
3630     {
3631         job->chapter_markers = 1;
3632         
3633         /* now lets get our saved chapter names out the array in the queue file
3634          * and insert them back into the title chapter list. We have it here,
3635          * because unless we are inserting chapter markers there is no need to
3636          * spend the overhead of iterating through the chapter names array imo
3637          * Also, note that if for some reason we don't apply chapter names, the
3638          * chapters just come out 001, 002, etc. etc.
3639          */
3640          
3641         NSMutableArray *ChapterNamesArray = [queueToApply objectForKey:@"ChapterNames"];
3642         int i = 0;
3643         NSEnumerator *enumerator = [ChapterNamesArray objectEnumerator];
3644         id tempObject;
3645         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
3646         {
3647             hb_chapter_t *chapter = (hb_chapter_t *) hb_list_item( title->list_chapter, i );
3648             if( chapter != NULL )
3649             {
3650                 strncpy( chapter->title, [tempObject UTF8String], 1023);
3651                 chapter->title[1023] = '\0';
3652             }
3653             i++;
3654         }
3655     }
3656     else
3657     {
3658         job->chapter_markers = 0;
3659     }
3660     
3661     if( job->vcodec & HB_VCODEC_X264 )
3662     {
3663                 if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Mp4iPodCompatible"] intValue] == 1)
3664             {
3665             job->ipod_atom = 1;
3666                 }
3667         else
3668         {
3669             job->ipod_atom = 0;
3670         }
3671                 
3672                 
3673                 /* Below Sends x264 options to the core library if x264 is selected*/
3674                 /* Lets use this as per Nyx, Thanks Nyx!*/
3675                 job->x264opts = (char *)calloc(1024, 1); /* Fixme, this just leaks */
3676                 /* Turbo first pass if two pass and Turbo First pass is selected */
3677                 if( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTwoPass"] intValue] == 1 && [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoTurboTwoPass"] intValue] == 1 )
3678                 {
3679                         /* pass the "Turbo" string to be appended to the existing x264 opts string into a variable for the first pass */
3680                         NSString *firstPassOptStringTurbo = @":ref=1:subme=2:me=dia:analyse=none:trellis=0:no-fast-pskip=0:8x8dct=0:weightb=0";
3681                         /* append the "Turbo" string variable to the existing opts string.
3682              Note: the "Turbo" string must be appended, not prepended to work properly*/
3683                         NSString *firstPassOptStringCombined = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"x264Option"] stringByAppendingString:firstPassOptStringTurbo];
3684                         strcpy(job->x264opts, [firstPassOptStringCombined UTF8String]);
3685                 }
3686                 else
3687                 {
3688                         strcpy(job->x264opts, [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"x264Option"] UTF8String]);
3689                 }
3690         
3691     }
3692     
3693     
3694     /* Picture Size Settings */
3695     job->width = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureWidth"]  intValue];
3696     job->height = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureHeight"]  intValue];
3697     
3698     job->keep_ratio = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"]  intValue];
3699     job->anamorphic.mode = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePAR"]  intValue];
3700     job->modulus = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureModulus"] intValue];
3701     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePAR"]  intValue] == 3)
3702     {
3703         /* insert our custom values here for capuj */
3704         job->width = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARStorageWidth"]  intValue];
3705         job->height = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARStorageHeight"]  intValue];
3706         
3707         job->modulus = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARModulus"] intValue];
3708         
3709         job->anamorphic.par_width = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARPixelWidth"]  intValue];
3710         job->anamorphic.par_height = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARPixelHeight"]  intValue];
3711         
3712         job->anamorphic.dar_width = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARDisplayWidth"]  floatValue];
3713         job->anamorphic.dar_height = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PicturePARDisplayHeight"]  floatValue];
3714     }
3715     
3716     /* Here we use the crop values saved at the time the preset was saved */
3717     job->crop[0] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureTopCrop"]  intValue];
3718     job->crop[1] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"]  intValue];
3719     job->crop[2] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"]  intValue];
3720     job->crop[3] = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureRightCrop"]  intValue];
3721     
3722     /* Video settings */
3723     /* Framerate */
3724     
3725     /* Set vfr to 0 as it's only on if using same as source in the framerate popup
3726      * and detelecine is on, so we handle that in the logic below
3727      */
3728     job->vfr = 0;
3729     if( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobIndexVideoFramerate"] intValue] > 0 )
3730     {
3731         /* a specific framerate has been chosen */
3732         job->vrate      = 27000000;
3733         job->vrate_base = hb_video_rates[[[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobIndexVideoFramerate"] intValue]-1].rate;
3734         /* We are not same as source so we set job->cfr to 1 
3735          * to enable constant frame rate since user has specified
3736          * a specific framerate*/
3737         job->cfr = 1;
3738     }
3739     else
3740     {
3741         /* We are same as source (variable) */
3742         job->vrate      = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobVrate"] intValue];
3743         job->vrate_base = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobVrateBase"] intValue];
3744         /* We are same as source so we set job->cfr to 0 
3745          * to enable true same as source framerate */
3746         job->cfr = 0;
3747         /* If we are same as source and we have detelecine on, we need to turn on
3748          * job->vfr
3749          */
3750         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] == 1)
3751         {
3752             job->vfr = 1;
3753         }
3754     }
3755     
3756     if ( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualityType"] intValue] != 2 )
3757     {
3758         /* Target size.
3759          Bitrate should already have been calculated and displayed
3760          in fVidBitrateField, so let's just use it same as abr*/
3761         job->vquality = -1.0;
3762         job->vbitrate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoAvgBitrate"] intValue];
3763     }
3764     if ( [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualityType"] intValue] == 2 )
3765     {
3766         job->vquality = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue];
3767         job->vbitrate = 0;
3768         
3769     }
3770     
3771     job->grayscale = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"VideoGrayScale"] intValue];
3772     
3773
3774
3775 #pragma mark -
3776 #pragma mark Process Subtitles to libhb
3777
3778 /* Map the settings in the dictionaries for the SubtitleList array to match title->list_subtitle
3779  * which means that we need to account for the offset of non source language settings in from
3780  * the NSPopUpCell menu. For all of the objects in the SubtitleList array this means 0 is "None"
3781  * from the popup menu, additionally the first track has "Foreign Audio Search" at 1. So we use
3782  * an int to offset the index number for the objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackNum" to map that
3783  * to the source tracks position in title->list_subtitle.
3784  */
3785
3786 int subtitle = nil;
3787 int force;
3788 int burned;
3789 int def;
3790 bool one_burned = FALSE;
3791
3792     int i = 0;
3793     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"SubtitleList"] objectEnumerator];
3794     id tempObject;
3795     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
3796     {
3797         
3798         subtitle = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackNum"] intValue];
3799         force = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackForced"] intValue];
3800         burned = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackBurned"] intValue];
3801         def = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackDefault"] intValue];
3802         
3803         /* since the subtitleSourceTrackNum 0 is "None" in our array of the subtitle popups,
3804          * we want to ignore it for display as well as encoding.
3805          */
3806         if (subtitle > 0)
3807         {
3808             /* if i is 0, then we are in the first item of the subtitles which we need to 
3809              * check for the "Foreign Audio Search" which would be subtitleSourceTrackNum of 1
3810              * bearing in mind that for all tracks subtitleSourceTrackNum of 0 is None.
3811              */
3812             
3813             /* if we are on the first track and using "Foreign Audio Search" */ 
3814             if (i == 0 && subtitle == 1)
3815             {
3816                 [self writeToActivityLog: "Foreign Language Search: %d", 1];
3817                 
3818                 job->indepth_scan = 1;
3819                 if (burned == 1 || job->mux != HB_MUX_MP4)
3820                 {
3821                     if (burned != 1 && job->mux == HB_MUX_MKV)
3822                     {
3823                         job->select_subtitle_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3824                     }
3825                     else
3826                     {
3827                         job->select_subtitle_config.dest = RENDERSUB;
3828                     }
3829                     
3830                     job->select_subtitle_config.force = force;
3831                     job->select_subtitle_config.default_track = def;
3832                 }
3833                 
3834                 
3835             }
3836             else
3837             {
3838                 
3839                 /* for the actual source tracks, we must subtract the non source entries so 
3840                  * that the menu index matches the source subtitle_list index for convenience */
3841                 if (i == 0)
3842                 {
3843                     /* for the first track, the source tracks start at menu index 2 ( None is 0,
3844                      * Foreign Language Search is 1) so subtract 2 */
3845                     subtitle = subtitle - 2;
3846                 }
3847                 else
3848                 {
3849                     /* for all other tracks, the source tracks start at menu index 1 (None is 0)
3850                      * so subtract 1. */
3851                     
3852                     subtitle = subtitle - 1;
3853                 }
3854                 
3855                 /* We are setting a source subtitle so access the source subtitle info */  
3856                 hb_subtitle_t * subt;
3857                 
3858                 subt = (hb_subtitle_t *)hb_list_item(title->list_subtitle, subtitle);
3859                 
3860                 /* if we are getting the subtitles from an external srt file */
3861                 if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceTrackType"] isEqualToString:@"SRT"])
3862                 {
3863                     hb_subtitle_config_t sub_config;
3864                     
3865                     sub_config.offset = [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtOffset"] intValue];
3866                     
3867                     /* we need to srncpy file name and codeset */
3868                     strncpy(sub_config.src_filename, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleSourceSrtFilePath"] UTF8String], 128);
3869                     strncpy(sub_config.src_codeset, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtCharCode"] UTF8String], 40);
3870                     
3871                     sub_config.force = 0;
3872                     sub_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3873                     sub_config.default_track = def;
3874                     
3875                     hb_srt_add( job, &sub_config, [[tempObject objectForKey:@"subtitleTrackSrtLanguageIso3"] UTF8String]);
3876                 }
3877                 
3878                 
3879                 if (subt != NULL)
3880                 {
3881                     hb_subtitle_config_t sub_config = subt->config;
3882                     
3883                     if (!burned && job->mux == HB_MUX_MKV && 
3884                         subt->format == PICTURESUB)
3885                     {
3886                         sub_config.dest = PASSTHRUSUB;
3887                     }
3888                     else if (!burned && job->mux == HB_MUX_MP4 && 
3889                              subt->format == PICTURESUB)
3890                     {
3891                         // Skip any non-burned vobsubs when output is mp4
3892                         continue;
3893                     }
3894                     else if ( burned && subt->format == PICTURESUB )
3895                     {
3896                         // Only allow one subtitle to be burned into the video
3897                         if (one_burned)
3898                             continue;
3899                         one_burned = TRUE;
3900                     }
3901                     sub_config.force = force;
3902                     sub_config.default_track = def;
3903                     hb_subtitle_add( job, &sub_config, subtitle );
3904                 }   
3905                 
3906             }
3907         }
3908         i++;
3909     }
3910
3911 #pragma mark -
3912
3913    
3914     /* Audio tracks and mixdowns */
3915     /* Lets make sure there arent any erroneous audio tracks in the job list, so lets make sure its empty*/
3916     int audiotrack_count = hb_list_count(job->list_audio);
3917     for( int i = 0; i < audiotrack_count;i++)
3918     {
3919         hb_audio_t * temp_audio = (hb_audio_t*) hb_list_item( job->list_audio, 0 );
3920         hb_list_rem(job->list_audio, temp_audio);
3921     }
3922     /* Now lets add our new tracks to the audio list here */
3923     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] intValue] > 0)
3924     {
3925         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3926         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3927         audio->in.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] intValue] - 1;
3928         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3929         audio->out.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] intValue] - 1;
3930         audio->out.codec = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio1Encoder"] intValue];
3931         audio->out.mixdown = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio1Mixdown"] intValue];
3932         audio->out.bitrate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio1Bitrate"] intValue];
3933         audio->out.samplerate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio1Samplerate"] intValue];
3934         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio1TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue];
3935         
3936         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3937         free(audio);
3938     }  
3939     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] intValue] > 0)
3940     {
3941         
3942         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3943         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3944         audio->in.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] intValue] - 1;
3945         [self writeToActivityLog: "prepareJob audiotrack 2 is: %d", audio->in.track];
3946         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3947         audio->out.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] intValue] - 1;
3948         audio->out.codec = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio2Encoder"] intValue];
3949         audio->out.mixdown = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio2Mixdown"] intValue];
3950         audio->out.bitrate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio2Bitrate"] intValue];
3951         audio->out.samplerate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio2Samplerate"] intValue];
3952         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio2TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue];
3953         
3954         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3955         free(audio);
3956     }
3957     
3958     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] intValue] > 0)
3959     {
3960         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3961         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3962         audio->in.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] intValue] - 1;
3963         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3964         audio->out.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] intValue] - 1;
3965         audio->out.codec = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio3Encoder"] intValue];
3966         audio->out.mixdown = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio3Mixdown"] intValue];
3967         audio->out.bitrate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio3Bitrate"] intValue];
3968         audio->out.samplerate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio3Samplerate"] intValue];
3969         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio3TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue];
3970         
3971         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3972         free(audio);        
3973     }
3974     
3975     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] intValue] > 0)
3976     {
3977         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
3978         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
3979         audio->in.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] intValue] - 1;
3980         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
3981         audio->out.track = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] intValue] - 1;
3982         audio->out.codec = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio4Encoder"] intValue];
3983         audio->out.mixdown = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio4Mixdown"] intValue];
3984         audio->out.bitrate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio4Bitrate"] intValue];
3985         audio->out.samplerate = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"JobAudio4Samplerate"] intValue];
3986         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"Audio4TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue];
3987         
3988         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
3989         
3990
3991     }
3992     
3993     /* Filters */ 
3994     job->filters = hb_list_init();
3995     
3996     /* Now lets call the filters if applicable.
3997      * The order of the filters is critical
3998      */
3999     /* Detelecine */
4000     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] == 1)
4001     {
4002         /* use a custom detelecine string */
4003         hb_filter_detelecine.settings = (char *) [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecineCustom"] UTF8String];
4004         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_detelecine );
4005     }
4006     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] == 2)
4007     {
4008         /* Use libhb's default values */
4009         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_detelecine );
4010     }
4011     
4012     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecombDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1)
4013     {
4014         /* Decomb */
4015         /* we add the custom string if present */
4016         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] == 1)
4017         {
4018             /* use a custom decomb string */
4019             hb_filter_decomb.settings = (char *) [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecombCustom"] UTF8String];
4020             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_decomb );
4021         }
4022         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] == 2)
4023         {
4024             /* Use libhb default */
4025             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_decomb );
4026         }
4027         
4028     }
4029     else
4030     {
4031         
4032         /* Deinterlace */
4033         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1)
4034         {
4035             /* we add the custom string if present */
4036             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = (char *) [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlaceCustom"] UTF8String];
4037             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
4038         }
4039         else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 2)
4040         {
4041             /* Run old deinterlacer fd by default */
4042             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "-1"; 
4043             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );
4044         }
4045         else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 3)
4046         {
4047             /* Yadif mode 0 (without spatial deinterlacing.) */
4048             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "2"; 
4049             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
4050         }
4051         else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 4)
4052         {
4053             /* Yadif (with spatial deinterlacing) */
4054             hb_filter_deinterlace.settings = "0"; 
4055             hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deinterlace );            
4056         }
4057         
4058         
4059     }
4060     /* Denoise */
4061         if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 1) // Custom in popup
4062         {
4063                 /* we add the custom string if present */
4064         hb_filter_denoise.settings = (char *) [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoiseCustom"] UTF8String];
4065         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
4066         }
4067     else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 2) // Weak in popup
4068         {
4069                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "2:1:2:3"; 
4070         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
4071         }
4072         else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 3) // Medium in popup
4073         {
4074                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "3:2:2:3"; 
4075         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
4076         }
4077         else if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 4) // Strong in popup
4078         {
4079                 hb_filter_denoise.settings = "7:7:5:5"; 
4080         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_denoise );        
4081         }
4082     
4083     
4084     /* Deblock  (uses pp7 default) */
4085     /* NOTE: even though there is a valid deblock setting of 0 for the filter, for 
4086      * the macgui's purposes a value of 0 actually means to not even use the filter
4087      * current hb_filter_deblock.settings valid ranges are from 5 - 15 
4088      */
4089     if ([[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] intValue] != 0)
4090     {
4091         hb_filter_deblock.settings = (char *) [[queueToApply objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] UTF8String];
4092         hb_list_add( job->filters, &hb_filter_deblock );
4093     }
4094 [self writeToActivityLog: "prepareJob exiting"];    
4095 }
4096
4097
4098
4099 /* addToQueue: puts up an alert before ultimately calling doAddToQueue
4100 */
4101 - (IBAction) addToQueue: (id) sender
4102 {
4103         /* We get the destination directory from the destination field here */
4104         NSString *destinationDirectory = [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
4105         /* We check for a valid destination here */
4106         if ([[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:destinationDirectory] == 0) 
4107         {
4108                 NSRunAlertPanel(@"Warning!", @"This is not a valid destination directory!", @"OK", nil, nil);
4109         return;
4110         }
4111     
4112     BOOL fileExists;
4113     fileExists = NO;
4114     
4115     BOOL fileExistsInQueue;
4116     fileExistsInQueue = NO;
4117     
4118     /* We check for and existing file here */
4119     if([[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath: [fDstFile2Field stringValue]])
4120     {
4121         fileExists = YES;
4122     }
4123     
4124     /* We now run through the queue and make sure we are not overwriting an exisiting queue item */
4125     int i = 0;
4126     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [QueueFileArray objectEnumerator];
4127         id tempObject;
4128         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
4129         {
4130                 NSDictionary *thisQueueDict = tempObject;
4131                 if ([[thisQueueDict objectForKey:@"DestinationPath"] isEqualToString: [fDstFile2Field stringValue]])
4132                 {
4133                         fileExistsInQueue = YES;        
4134                 }
4135         i++;
4136         }
4137     
4138     
4139         if(fileExists == YES)
4140     {
4141         NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet( NSLocalizedString( @"File already exists.", @"" ),
4142                                   NSLocalizedString( @"Cancel", @"" ), NSLocalizedString( @"Overwrite", @"" ), nil, fWindow, self,
4143                                   @selector( overwriteAddToQueueAlertDone:returnCode:contextInfo: ),
4144                                   NULL, NULL, [NSString stringWithFormat:
4145                                                NSLocalizedString( @"Do you want to overwrite %@?", @"" ),
4146                                                [fDstFile2Field stringValue]] );
4147     }
4148     else if (fileExistsInQueue == YES)
4149     {
4150     NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet( NSLocalizedString( @"There is already a queue item for this destination.", @"" ),
4151                                   NSLocalizedString( @"Cancel", @"" ), NSLocalizedString( @"Overwrite", @"" ), nil, fWindow, self,
4152                                   @selector( overwriteAddToQueueAlertDone:returnCode:contextInfo: ),
4153                                   NULL, NULL, [NSString stringWithFormat:
4154                                                NSLocalizedString( @"Do you want to overwrite %@?", @"" ),
4155                                                [fDstFile2Field stringValue]] );
4156     }
4157     else
4158     {
4159         [self doAddToQueue];
4160     }
4161 }
4162
4163 /* overwriteAddToQueueAlertDone: called from the alert posted by addToQueue that asks
4164    the user if they want to overwrite an exiting movie file.
4165 */
4166 - (void) overwriteAddToQueueAlertDone: (NSWindow *) sheet
4167     returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
4168 {
4169     if( returnCode == NSAlertAlternateReturn )
4170         [self doAddToQueue];
4171 }
4172
4173 - (void) doAddToQueue
4174 {
4175     [self addQueueFileItem ];
4176 }
4177
4178
4179
4180 /* Rip: puts up an alert before ultimately calling doRip
4181 */
4182 - (IBAction) Rip: (id) sender
4183 {
4184     [self writeToActivityLog: "Rip: Pending queue count is %d", fPendingCount];
4185     /* Rip or Cancel ? */
4186     hb_state_t s;
4187     hb_get_state2( fQueueEncodeLibhb, &s );
4188     
4189     if(s.state == HB_STATE_WORKING || s.state == HB_STATE_PAUSED)
4190         {
4191         [self Cancel: sender];
4192         return;
4193     }
4194     
4195     /* We check to see if we need to warn the user that the computer will go to sleep
4196                  or shut down when encoding is finished */
4197                 [self remindUserOfSleepOrShutdown];
4198     
4199     // If there are pending jobs in the queue, then this is a rip the queue
4200     if (fPendingCount > 0)
4201     {
4202         /* here lets start the queue with the first pending item */
4203         [self performNewQueueScan:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SourcePath"] scanTitleNum:[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"]intValue]]; 
4204         
4205         return;
4206     }
4207     
4208     // Before adding jobs to the queue, check for a valid destination.
4209     
4210     NSString *destinationDirectory = [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
4211     if ([[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:destinationDirectory] == 0) 
4212     {
4213         NSRunAlertPanel(@"Warning!", @"This is not a valid destination directory!", @"OK", nil, nil);
4214         return;
4215     }
4216     
4217     /* We check for duplicate name here */
4218     if( [[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:[fDstFile2Field stringValue]] )
4219     {
4220         NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet( NSLocalizedString( @"File already exists", @"" ),
4221                                   NSLocalizedString( @"Cancel", "" ), NSLocalizedString( @"Overwrite", @"" ), nil, fWindow, self,
4222                                   @selector( overWriteAlertDone:returnCode:contextInfo: ),
4223                                   NULL, NULL, [NSString stringWithFormat:
4224                                                NSLocalizedString( @"Do you want to overwrite %@?", @"" ),
4225                                                [fDstFile2Field stringValue]] );
4226         
4227         // overWriteAlertDone: will be called when the alert is dismissed. It will call doRip.
4228     }
4229     else
4230     {
4231         /* if there are no pending jobs in the queue, then add this one to the queue and rip
4232          otherwise, just rip the queue */
4233         if(fPendingCount == 0)
4234         {
4235             [self doAddToQueue];
4236         }
4237         
4238         /* go right to processing the new queue encode */
4239         [self performNewQueueScan:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SourcePath"] scanTitleNum:[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"]intValue]]; 
4240         
4241     }
4242 }
4243
4244 /* overWriteAlertDone: called from the alert posted by Rip: that asks the user if they
4245    want to overwrite an exiting movie file.
4246 */
4247 - (void) overWriteAlertDone: (NSWindow *) sheet
4248     returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
4249 {
4250     if( returnCode == NSAlertAlternateReturn )
4251     {
4252         /* if there are no jobs in the queue, then add this one to the queue and rip 
4253         otherwise, just rip the queue */
4254         if( fPendingCount == 0 )
4255         {
4256             [self doAddToQueue];
4257         }
4258
4259         NSString *destinationDirectory = [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
4260         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:destinationDirectory forKey:@"LastDestinationDirectory"];
4261         [self performNewQueueScan:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SourcePath"] scanTitleNum:[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"]intValue]]; 
4262       
4263     }
4264 }
4265
4266 - (void) remindUserOfSleepOrShutdown
4267 {
4268        if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Put Computer To Sleep"])
4269        {
4270                /*Warn that computer will sleep after encoding*/
4271                int reminduser;
4272                NSBeep();
4273                reminduser = NSRunAlertPanel(@"The computer will sleep after encoding is done.",@"You have selected to sleep the computer after encoding. To turn off sleeping, go to the HandBrake preferences.", @"OK", @"Preferences...", nil);
4274                [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
4275                if ( reminduser == NSAlertAlternateReturn )
4276                {
4277                        [self showPreferencesWindow:nil];
4278                }
4279        }
4280        else if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"AlertWhenDone"] isEqualToString: @"Shut Down Computer"])
4281        {
4282                /*Warn that computer will shut down after encoding*/
4283                int reminduser;
4284                NSBeep();
4285                reminduser = NSRunAlertPanel(@"The computer will shut down after encoding is done.",@"You have selected to shut down the computer after encoding. To turn off shut down, go to the HandBrake preferences.", @"OK", @"Preferences...", nil);
4286                [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
4287                if ( reminduser == NSAlertAlternateReturn )
4288                {
4289                        [self showPreferencesWindow:nil];
4290                }
4291        }
4292
4293 }
4294
4295
4296 - (void) doRip
4297 {
4298     /* Let libhb do the job */
4299     hb_start( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4300     /*set the fEncodeState State */
4301         fEncodeState = 1;
4302 }
4303
4304
4305 //------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4306 // Displays an alert asking user if the want to cancel encoding of current job.
4307 // Cancel: returns immediately after posting the alert. Later, when the user
4308 // acknowledges the alert, doCancelCurrentJob is called.
4309 //------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4310 - (IBAction)Cancel: (id)sender
4311 {
4312     if (!fQueueController) return;
4313     
4314   hb_pause( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4315     NSString * alertTitle = [NSString stringWithFormat:NSLocalizedString(@"You are currently encoding. What would you like to do ?", nil)];
4316    
4317     // Which window to attach the sheet to?
4318     NSWindow * docWindow;
4319     if ([sender respondsToSelector: @selector(window)])
4320         docWindow = [sender window];
4321     else
4322         docWindow = fWindow;
4323         
4324     NSBeginCriticalAlertSheet(
4325             alertTitle,
4326             NSLocalizedString(@"Continue Encoding", nil),
4327             NSLocalizedString(@"Cancel Current and Stop", nil),
4328             NSLocalizedString(@"Cancel Current and Continue", nil),
4329             docWindow, self,
4330             nil, @selector(didDimissCancel:returnCode:contextInfo:), nil,
4331             NSLocalizedString(@"Your encode will be cancelled if you don't continue encoding.", nil));
4332     
4333     // didDimissCancelCurrentJob:returnCode:contextInfo: will be called when the dialog is dismissed
4334 }
4335
4336 - (void) didDimissCancel: (NSWindow *)sheet returnCode: (int)returnCode contextInfo: (void *)contextInfo
4337 {
4338    hb_resume( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4339      if (returnCode == NSAlertOtherReturn)
4340     {
4341         [self doCancelCurrentJob];  // <- this also stops libhb
4342     }
4343     if (returnCode == NSAlertAlternateReturn)
4344     {
4345     [self doCancelCurrentJobAndStop];
4346     }
4347 }
4348
4349 //------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4350 // Cancels and deletes the current job and stops libhb from processing the remaining
4351 // encodes.
4352 //------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
4353 - (void) doCancelCurrentJob
4354 {
4355     // Stop the current job. hb_stop will only cancel the current pass and then set
4356     // its state to HB_STATE_WORKDONE. It also does this asynchronously. So when we
4357     // see the state has changed to HB_STATE_WORKDONE (in updateUI), we'll delete the
4358     // remaining passes of the job and then start the queue back up if there are any
4359     // remaining jobs.
4360      
4361     
4362     hb_stop( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4363     
4364     // Delete all remaining jobs since libhb doesn't do this on its own.
4365             hb_job_t * job;
4366             while( ( job = hb_job(fQueueEncodeLibhb, 0) ) )
4367                 hb_rem( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
4368                 
4369     fEncodeState = 2;   // don't alert at end of processing since this was a cancel
4370     
4371     // now that we've stopped the currently encoding job, lets mark it as cancelled
4372     [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:3] forKey:@"Status"];
4373     // and as always, save it in the queue .plist...
4374     /* We save all of the Queue data here */
4375     [self saveQueueFileItem];
4376     // so now lets move to 
4377     currentQueueEncodeIndex++ ;
4378     // ... and see if there are more items left in our queue
4379     int queueItems = [QueueFileArray count];
4380     /* If we still have more items in our queue, lets go to the next one */
4381     if (currentQueueEncodeIndex < queueItems)
4382     {
4383     [self writeToActivityLog: "doCancelCurrentJob currentQueueEncodeIndex is incremented to: %d", currentQueueEncodeIndex];
4384     [self writeToActivityLog: "doCancelCurrentJob moving to the next job"];
4385     
4386     [self performNewQueueScan:[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"SourcePath"] scanTitleNum:[[[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] objectForKey:@"TitleNumber"]intValue]];
4387     }
4388     else
4389     {
4390         [self writeToActivityLog: "doCancelCurrentJob the item queue is complete"];
4391     }
4392
4393 }
4394
4395 - (void) doCancelCurrentJobAndStop
4396 {
4397     hb_stop( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4398     
4399     // Delete all remaining jobs since libhb doesn't do this on its own.
4400             hb_job_t * job;
4401             while( ( job = hb_job(fQueueEncodeLibhb, 0) ) )
4402                 hb_rem( fQueueEncodeLibhb, job );
4403                 
4404                 
4405     fEncodeState = 2;   // don't alert at end of processing since this was a cancel
4406     
4407     // now that we've stopped the currently encoding job, lets mark it as cancelled
4408     [[QueueFileArray objectAtIndex:currentQueueEncodeIndex] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:3] forKey:@"Status"];
4409     // and as always, save it in the queue .plist...
4410     /* We save all of the Queue data here */
4411     [self saveQueueFileItem];
4412     // so now lets move to 
4413     currentQueueEncodeIndex++ ;
4414     [self writeToActivityLog: "cancelling current job and stopping the queue"];
4415 }
4416 - (IBAction) Pause: (id) sender
4417 {
4418     hb_state_t s;
4419     hb_get_state2( fQueueEncodeLibhb, &s );
4420
4421     if( s.state == HB_STATE_PAUSED )
4422     {
4423         hb_resume( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4424     }
4425     else
4426     {
4427         hb_pause( fQueueEncodeLibhb );
4428     }
4429 }
4430
4431 #pragma mark -
4432 #pragma mark GUI Controls Changed Methods
4433
4434 - (IBAction) titlePopUpChanged: (id) sender
4435 {
4436     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
4437     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t*)
4438         hb_list_item( list, [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
4439
4440     /* If we are a stream type and a batch scan, grok the output file name from title->name upon title change */
4441     if (title->type == HB_STREAM_TYPE && hb_list_count( list ) > 1 )
4442     {
4443         /* we set the default name according to the new title->name */
4444         [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
4445                                          @"%@/%@.%@", [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent],
4446                                          [NSString stringWithUTF8String: title->name],
4447                                          [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] pathExtension]]];
4448         
4449         /* Change the source to read out the parent folder also */
4450         [fSrcDVD2Field setStringValue:[NSString stringWithFormat:@"%@/%@", browsedSourceDisplayName,[NSString stringWithUTF8String: title->name]]];
4451     }
4452     
4453     /* For point a to point b pts encoding, set the start and end fields to 0 and the title duration in seconds respectively */
4454     int duration = (title->hours * 3600) + (title->minutes * 60) + (title->seconds);
4455     [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", 0]];
4456     [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", duration]];
4457     /* For point a to point b frame encoding, set the start and end fields to 0 and the title duration * announced fps in seconds respectively */
4458     [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", 1]];
4459     //[fSrcFrameEndEncodingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", ((title->hours * 3600) + (title->minutes * 60) + (title->seconds)) * 24]];
4460     [fSrcFrameEndEncodingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", duration * (title->rate / title->rate_base)]];    
4461     
4462     /* If Auto Naming is on. We create an output filename of dvd name - title number */
4463     if( [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"DefaultAutoNaming"] > 0 && ( hb_list_count( list ) > 1 ) )
4464         {
4465                 [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
4466                         @"%@/%@-%d.%@", [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent],
4467                         [browsedSourceDisplayName stringByDeletingPathExtension],
4468             title->index,
4469                         [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] pathExtension]]]; 
4470         }
4471     /* Update encode start / stop variables */
4472      
4473     
4474     
4475     /* Update chapter popups */
4476     [fSrcChapterStartPopUp removeAllItems];
4477     [fSrcChapterEndPopUp   removeAllItems];
4478     for( int i = 0; i < hb_list_count( title->list_chapter ); i++ )
4479     {
4480         [fSrcChapterStartPopUp addItemWithTitle: [NSString
4481             stringWithFormat: @"%d", i + 1]];
4482         [fSrcChapterEndPopUp addItemWithTitle: [NSString
4483             stringWithFormat: @"%d", i + 1]];
4484     }
4485
4486     [fSrcChapterStartPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
4487     [fSrcChapterEndPopUp   selectItemAtIndex:
4488         hb_list_count( title->list_chapter ) - 1];
4489     [self chapterPopUpChanged:nil];
4490     
4491     /* if using dvd nav, show the angle widget */
4492     if ([[[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] objectForKey:@"UseDvdNav"] boolValue])
4493     {
4494         [fSrcAngleLabel setHidden:NO];
4495         [fSrcAnglePopUp setHidden:NO];
4496         
4497         [fSrcAnglePopUp removeAllItems];
4498         for( int i = 0; i < title->angle_count; i++ )
4499         {
4500             [fSrcAnglePopUp addItemWithTitle: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", i + 1]];
4501         }
4502         [fSrcAnglePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
4503     }
4504     else
4505     {
4506         [fSrcAngleLabel setHidden:YES];
4507         [fSrcAnglePopUp setHidden:YES];
4508     }
4509     
4510     /* Start Get and set the initial pic size for display */
4511         hb_job_t * job = title->job;
4512         fTitle = title;
4513     
4514     /* Set Auto Crop to on upon selecting a new title  */
4515     [fPictureController setAutoCrop:YES];
4516     
4517         /* We get the originial output picture width and height and put them
4518         in variables for use with some presets later on */
4519         PicOrigOutputWidth = job->width;
4520         PicOrigOutputHeight = job->height;
4521         AutoCropTop = job->crop[0];
4522         AutoCropBottom = job->crop[1];
4523         AutoCropLeft = job->crop[2];
4524         AutoCropRight = job->crop[3];
4525
4526         /* Reset the new title in fPictureController &&  fPreviewController*/
4527     [fPictureController SetTitle:title];
4528
4529         
4530     /* Update Subtitle Table */
4531     [fSubtitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:title];
4532     [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];
4533     
4534
4535     /* Update chapter table */
4536     [fChapterTitlesDelegate resetWithTitle:title];
4537     [fChapterTable reloadData];
4538
4539    /* Lets make sure there arent any erroneous audio tracks in the job list, so lets make sure its empty*/
4540     int audiotrack_count = hb_list_count(job->list_audio);
4541     for( int i = 0; i < audiotrack_count;i++)
4542     {
4543         hb_audio_t * temp_audio = (hb_audio_t*) hb_list_item( job->list_audio, 0 );
4544         hb_list_rem(job->list_audio, temp_audio);
4545     }
4546
4547     /* Update audio popups */
4548     [self addAllAudioTracksToPopUp: fAudLang1PopUp];
4549     [self addAllAudioTracksToPopUp: fAudLang2PopUp];
4550     [self addAllAudioTracksToPopUp: fAudLang3PopUp];
4551     [self addAllAudioTracksToPopUp: fAudLang4PopUp];
4552     /* search for the first instance of our prefs default language for track 1, and set track 2 to "none" */
4553         NSString * audioSearchPrefix = [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"DefaultLanguage"];
4554         [self selectAudioTrackInPopUp: fAudLang1PopUp searchPrefixString: audioSearchPrefix selectIndexIfNotFound: 1];
4555     [self selectAudioTrackInPopUp:fAudLang2PopUp searchPrefixString:nil selectIndexIfNotFound:0];
4556     [self selectAudioTrackInPopUp:fAudLang3PopUp searchPrefixString:nil selectIndexIfNotFound:0];
4557     [self selectAudioTrackInPopUp:fAudLang4PopUp searchPrefixString:nil selectIndexIfNotFound:0];
4558
4559         /* changing the title may have changed the audio channels on offer, */
4560         /* so call audioTrackPopUpChanged for both audio tracks to update the mixdown popups */
4561         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang1PopUp];
4562         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
4563     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
4564     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
4565
4566     [fVidRatePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
4567
4568     /* we run the picture size values through calculatePictureSizing to get all picture setting information*/
4569         [self calculatePictureSizing:nil];
4570
4571    /* lets call tableViewSelected to make sure that any preset we have selected is enforced after a title change */
4572     [self selectPreset:nil];
4573 }
4574
4575 - (IBAction) encodeStartStopPopUpChanged: (id) sender;
4576 {
4577     if( [fEncodeStartStopPopUp isEnabled] )
4578     {
4579         /* We are chapters */
4580         if( [fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0 )
4581         {
4582             [fSrcChapterStartPopUp  setHidden: NO];
4583             [fSrcChapterEndPopUp  setHidden: NO];
4584             
4585             [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4586             [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4587             
4588             [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4589             [fSrcFrameEndEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4590             
4591                [self chapterPopUpChanged:nil];   
4592         }
4593         /* We are time based (seconds) */
4594         else if ([fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 1)
4595         {
4596             [fSrcChapterStartPopUp  setHidden: YES];
4597             [fSrcChapterEndPopUp  setHidden: YES];
4598             
4599             [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField  setHidden: NO];
4600             [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField  setHidden: NO];
4601             
4602             [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4603             [fSrcFrameEndEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4604             
4605             [self startEndSecValueChanged:nil];
4606         }
4607         /* We are frame based */
4608         else if ([fEncodeStartStopPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 2)
4609         {
4610             [fSrcChapterStartPopUp  setHidden: YES];
4611             [fSrcChapterEndPopUp  setHidden: YES];
4612             
4613             [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4614             [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField  setHidden: YES];
4615             
4616             [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField  setHidden: NO];
4617             [fSrcFrameEndEncodingField  setHidden: NO];
4618             
4619             [self startEndFrameValueChanged:nil];
4620         }
4621     }
4622 }
4623
4624 - (IBAction) chapterPopUpChanged: (id) sender
4625 {
4626
4627         /* If start chapter popup is greater than end chapter popup,
4628         we set the end chapter popup to the same as start chapter popup */
4629         if ([fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > [fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem])
4630         {
4631                 [fSrcChapterEndPopUp selectItemAtIndex: [fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem]];
4632     }
4633
4634                 
4635         hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
4636     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *)
4637         hb_list_item( list, [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
4638
4639     hb_chapter_t * chapter;
4640     int64_t        duration = 0;
4641     for( int i = [fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem];
4642          i <= [fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem]; i++ )
4643     {
4644         chapter = (hb_chapter_t *) hb_list_item( title->list_chapter, i );
4645         duration += chapter->duration;
4646     }
4647     
4648     duration /= 90000; /* pts -> seconds */
4649     [fSrcDuration2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
4650         @"%02lld:%02lld:%02lld", duration / 3600, ( duration / 60 ) % 60,
4651         duration % 60]];
4652     
4653     [self calculateBitrate: sender];
4654     
4655     if ( [fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] ==  [fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] )
4656     {
4657     /* Disable chapter markers for any source with less than two chapters as it makes no sense. */
4658     [fCreateChapterMarkers setEnabled: NO];
4659     [fCreateChapterMarkers setState: NSOffState];
4660     }
4661     else
4662     {
4663     [fCreateChapterMarkers setEnabled: YES];
4664     }
4665 }
4666
4667 - (IBAction) startEndSecValueChanged: (id) sender
4668 {
4669
4670         int duration = [fSrcTimeEndEncodingField intValue] - [fSrcTimeStartEncodingField intValue];
4671     [fSrcDuration2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
4672         @"%02d:%02d:%02d", duration / 3600, ( duration / 60 ) % 60,
4673         duration % 60]];
4674     
4675     //[self calculateBitrate: sender];
4676     
4677 }
4678
4679 - (IBAction) startEndFrameValueChanged: (id) sender
4680 {
4681     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
4682     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t*)
4683     hb_list_item( list, [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
4684     
4685     int duration = ([fSrcFrameEndEncodingField intValue] - [fSrcFrameStartEncodingField intValue]) / (title->rate / title->rate_base);
4686     [fSrcDuration2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:
4687                                          @"%02d:%02d:%02d", duration / 3600, ( duration / 60 ) % 60,
4688                                          duration % 60]];
4689     
4690     //[self calculateBitrate: sender];
4691 }
4692
4693
4694 - (IBAction) formatPopUpChanged: (id) sender
4695 {
4696     NSString * string = [fDstFile2Field stringValue];
4697     int format = [fDstFormatPopUp indexOfSelectedItem];
4698     char * ext = NULL;
4699         /* Initially set the large file (64 bit formatting) output checkbox to hidden */
4700     [fDstMp4LargeFileCheck setHidden: YES];
4701     [fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck setHidden: YES];
4702     [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setHidden: YES];
4703     
4704     /* Update the Video Codec PopUp */
4705     /* lets get the tag of the currently selected item first so we might reset it later */
4706     int selectedVidEncoderTag;
4707     selectedVidEncoderTag = [[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag];
4708     
4709     /* Note: we now store the video encoder int values from common.c in the tags of each popup for easy retrieval later */
4710     [fVidEncoderPopUp removeAllItems];
4711     NSMenuItem *menuItem;
4712     /* These video encoders are available to all of our current muxers, so lets list them once here */
4713     menuItem = [[fVidEncoderPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"MPEG-4 (FFmpeg)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
4714     [menuItem setTag: HB_VCODEC_FFMPEG];
4715     
4716     switch( format )
4717     {
4718         case 0:
4719                         /*Get Default MP4 File Extension*/
4720                         if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"DefaultMpegName"] > 0)
4721                         {
4722                                 ext = "m4v";
4723                         }
4724                         else
4725                         {
4726                                 ext = "mp4";
4727                         }
4728             /* Add additional video encoders here */
4729             menuItem = [[fVidEncoderPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"H.264 (x264)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
4730             [menuItem setTag: HB_VCODEC_X264];
4731             /* We show the mp4 option checkboxes here since we are mp4 */
4732             [fCreateChapterMarkers setEnabled: YES];
4733                         [fDstMp4LargeFileCheck setHidden: NO];
4734                         [fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck setHidden: NO];
4735             [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setHidden: NO];
4736             break;
4737             
4738             case 1:
4739             ext = "mkv";
4740             /* Add additional video encoders here */
4741             menuItem = [[fVidEncoderPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"H.264 (x264)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
4742             [menuItem setTag: HB_VCODEC_X264];
4743             menuItem = [[fVidEncoderPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"VP3 (Theora)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
4744             [menuItem setTag: HB_VCODEC_THEORA];
4745             /* We enable the create chapters checkbox here */
4746                         [fCreateChapterMarkers setEnabled: YES];
4747                         break;
4748             
4749
4750     }
4751     /* tell fSubtitlesDelegate we have a new video container */
4752     
4753     [fSubtitlesDelegate containerChanged:[[fDstFormatPopUp selectedItem] tag]];
4754     [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];
4755     /* if we have a previously selected vid encoder tag, then try to select it */
4756     if (selectedVidEncoderTag)
4757     {
4758         [fVidEncoderPopUp selectItemWithTag: selectedVidEncoderTag];
4759     }
4760     else
4761     {
4762         [fVidEncoderPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
4763     }
4764
4765     [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack1CodecPopUp];
4766     [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack2CodecPopUp];
4767     [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack3CodecPopUp];
4768     [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack4CodecPopUp];
4769
4770     if( format == 0 )
4771         [self autoSetM4vExtension: sender];
4772     else
4773         [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"%@.%s", [string stringByDeletingPathExtension], ext]];
4774
4775     if( SuccessfulScan )
4776     {
4777         /* Add/replace to the correct extension */
4778         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang1PopUp];
4779         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
4780         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
4781         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
4782
4783         if( [fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] == nil )
4784         {
4785
4786             [fVidEncoderPopUp selectItemAtIndex:0];
4787             [self videoEncoderPopUpChanged:nil];
4788
4789             /* changing the format may mean that we can / can't offer mono or 6ch, */
4790             /* so call audioTrackPopUpChanged for both audio tracks to update the mixdown popups */
4791
4792             /* We call the method to properly enable/disable turbo 2 pass */
4793             [self twoPassCheckboxChanged: sender];
4794             /* We call method method to change UI to reflect whether a preset is used or not*/
4795         }
4796     }
4797         [self customSettingUsed: sender];
4798 }
4799
4800 - (IBAction) autoSetM4vExtension: (id) sender
4801 {
4802     if ( [fDstFormatPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] )
4803         return;
4804
4805     NSString * extension = @"mp4";
4806
4807     if( [[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 ||
4808                                                         [[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 ||
4809                                                         [[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 ||
4810                                                         [fCreateChapterMarkers state] == NSOnState ||
4811                                                         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"DefaultMpegName"] > 0 )
4812     {
4813         extension = @"m4v";
4814     }
4815
4816     if( [extension isEqualTo: [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] pathExtension]] )
4817         return;
4818     else
4819         [fDstFile2Field setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"%@.%@",
4820                                     [[fDstFile2Field stringValue] stringByDeletingPathExtension], extension]];
4821 }
4822
4823 /* Method to determine if we should change the UI
4824 To reflect whether or not a Preset is being used or if
4825 the user is using "Custom" settings by determining the sender*/
4826 - (IBAction) customSettingUsed: (id) sender
4827 {
4828         if ([sender stringValue])
4829         {
4830                 /* Deselect the currently selected Preset if there is one*/
4831                 [fPresetsOutlineView deselectRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
4832                 /* Change UI to show "Custom" settings are being used */
4833                 [fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue: @"Custom"];
4834
4835                 curUserPresetChosenNum = nil;
4836         }
4837 [self calculateBitrate:nil];
4838 }
4839
4840
4841 #pragma mark -
4842 #pragma mark - Video
4843
4844 - (IBAction) videoEncoderPopUpChanged: (id) sender
4845 {
4846     hb_job_t * job = fTitle->job;
4847     int videoEncoder = [[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag];
4848     
4849     [fAdvancedOptions setHidden:YES];
4850     /* If we are using x264 then show the x264 advanced panel*/
4851     if (videoEncoder == HB_VCODEC_X264)
4852     {
4853         [fAdvancedOptions setHidden:NO];
4854         [self autoSetM4vExtension: sender];
4855     }
4856
4857     if (videoEncoder == HB_VCODEC_FFMPEG)
4858     {
4859         /* We set the iPod atom checkbox to disabled and uncheck it as its only for x264 in the mp4
4860          container. Format is taken care of in formatPopUpChanged method by hiding and unchecking
4861          anything other than MP4.
4862          */ 
4863         [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setEnabled: NO];
4864         [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setState: NSOffState];
4865     }
4866     else
4867     {
4868         [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setEnabled: YES];
4869     }
4870     [self setupQualitySlider];
4871         [self calculatePictureSizing: sender];
4872         [self twoPassCheckboxChanged: sender];
4873 }
4874
4875
4876 - (IBAction) twoPassCheckboxChanged: (id) sender
4877 {
4878         /* check to see if x264 is chosen */
4879         if([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_X264)
4880     {
4881                 if( [fVidTwoPassCheck state] == NSOnState)
4882                 {
4883                         [fVidTurboPassCheck setHidden: NO];
4884                 }
4885                 else
4886                 {
4887                         [fVidTurboPassCheck setHidden: YES];
4888                         [fVidTurboPassCheck setState: NSOffState];
4889                 }
4890                 /* Make sure Two Pass is checked if Turbo is checked */
4891                 if( [fVidTurboPassCheck state] == NSOnState)
4892                 {
4893                         [fVidTwoPassCheck setState: NSOnState];
4894                 }
4895         }
4896         else
4897         {
4898                 [fVidTurboPassCheck setHidden: YES];
4899                 [fVidTurboPassCheck setState: NSOffState];
4900         }
4901         
4902         /* We call method method to change UI to reflect whether a preset is used or not*/
4903         [self customSettingUsed: sender];
4904 }
4905
4906 - (IBAction ) videoFrameRateChanged: (id) sender
4907 {
4908     /* We call method method to calculatePictureSizing to error check detelecine*/
4909     [self calculatePictureSizing: sender];
4910
4911     /* We call method method to change UI to reflect whether a preset is used or not*/
4912         [self customSettingUsed: sender];
4913 }
4914 - (IBAction) videoMatrixChanged: (id) sender;
4915 {
4916     bool target, bitrate, quality;
4917
4918     target = bitrate = quality = false;
4919     if( [fVidQualityMatrix isEnabled] )
4920     {
4921         switch( [fVidQualityMatrix selectedRow] )
4922         {
4923             case 0:
4924                 target = true;
4925                 break;
4926             case 1:
4927                 bitrate = true;
4928                 break;
4929             case 2:
4930                 quality = true;
4931                 break;
4932         }
4933     }
4934     [fVidTargetSizeField  setEnabled: target];
4935     [fVidBitrateField     setEnabled: bitrate];
4936     [fVidQualitySlider    setEnabled: quality];
4937     [fVidQualityRFField   setEnabled: quality];
4938     [fVidQualityRFLabel    setEnabled: quality];
4939     [fVidTwoPassCheck     setEnabled: !quality &&
4940         [fVidQualityMatrix isEnabled]];
4941     if( quality )
4942     {
4943         [fVidTwoPassCheck setState: NSOffState];
4944                 [fVidTurboPassCheck setHidden: YES];
4945                 [fVidTurboPassCheck setState: NSOffState];
4946     }
4947
4948     [self qualitySliderChanged: sender];
4949     [self calculateBitrate: sender];
4950         [self customSettingUsed: sender];
4951 }
4952
4953 /* Use this method to setup the quality slider for cq/rf values depending on
4954  * the video encoder selected.
4955  */
4956 - (void) setupQualitySlider
4957 {
4958     /* Get the current slider maxValue to check for a change in slider scale later
4959      * so that we can choose a new similar value on the new slider scale */
4960     float previousMaxValue = [fVidQualitySlider maxValue];
4961     float previousPercentOfSliderScale = [fVidQualitySlider floatValue] / ([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider minValue] + 1);
4962     NSString * qpRFLabelString = @"QP:";
4963     /* x264 0-51 */
4964     if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_X264)
4965     {
4966         [fVidQualitySlider setMinValue:0.0];
4967         [fVidQualitySlider setMaxValue:51.0];
4968         /* As x264 allows for qp/rf values that are fractional, we get the value from the preferences */
4969         int fractionalGranularity = 1 / [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] floatForKey:@"x264CqSliderFractional"];
4970         [fVidQualitySlider setNumberOfTickMarks:(([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider minValue]) * fractionalGranularity) + 1];
4971         qpRFLabelString = @"RF:";
4972     }
4973     /* ffmpeg  1-31 */
4974     if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_FFMPEG )
4975     {
4976         [fVidQualitySlider setMinValue:1.0];
4977         [fVidQualitySlider setMaxValue:31.0];
4978         [fVidQualitySlider setNumberOfTickMarks:31];
4979     }
4980     /* Theora 0-63 */
4981     if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_THEORA)
4982     {
4983         [fVidQualitySlider setMinValue:0.0];
4984         [fVidQualitySlider setMaxValue:63.0];
4985         [fVidQualitySlider setNumberOfTickMarks:64];
4986     }
4987     [fVidQualityRFLabel setStringValue:qpRFLabelString];
4988     
4989     /* check to see if we have changed slider scales */
4990     if (previousMaxValue != [fVidQualitySlider maxValue])
4991     {
4992         /* if so, convert the old setting to the new scale as close as possible based on percentages */
4993         float rf =  ([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider minValue] + 1) * previousPercentOfSliderScale;
4994         [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:rf];
4995     }
4996     
4997     [self qualitySliderChanged:nil];
4998 }
4999
5000 - (IBAction) qualitySliderChanged: (id) sender
5001 {
5002     /* Our constant quality slider is in a range based
5003      * on each encoders qp/rf values. The range depends
5004      * on the encoder. Also, the range is inverse of quality
5005      * for all of the encoders *except* for theora
5006      * (ie. as the "quality" goes up, the cq or rf value
5007      * actually goes down). Since the IB sliders always set
5008      * their max value at the right end of the slider, we
5009      * will calculate the inverse, so as the slider floatValue
5010      * goes up, we will show the inverse in the rf field
5011      * so, the floatValue at the right for x264 would be 51
5012      * and our rf field needs to show 0 and vice versa.
5013      */
5014     
5015     float sliderRfInverse = ([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider floatValue]) + [fVidQualitySlider minValue];
5016     /* If the encoder is theora, use the float, otherwise use the inverse float*/
5017     //float sliderRfToPercent;
5018     if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_THEORA)
5019     {
5020         [fVidQualityRFField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%.2f", [fVidQualitySlider floatValue]]];   
5021     }
5022     else
5023     {
5024         [fVidQualityRFField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%.2f", sliderRfInverse]];
5025     }
5026     [self customSettingUsed: sender];
5027 }
5028
5029 - (void) controlTextDidChange: (NSNotification *) notification
5030 {
5031     [self calculateBitrate:nil];
5032 }
5033
5034 - (IBAction) calculateBitrate: (id) sender
5035 {
5036     if( !fHandle || [fVidQualityMatrix selectedRow] != 0 || !SuccessfulScan )
5037     {
5038         return;
5039     }
5040
5041     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
5042     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t *) hb_list_item( list,
5043             [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
5044     hb_job_t * job = title->job;
5045     hb_audio_config_t * audio;
5046     /* For  hb_calc_bitrate in addition to the Target Size in MB out of the
5047      * Target Size Field, we also need the job info for the Muxer, the Chapters
5048      * as well as all of the audio track info.
5049      * This used to be accomplished by simply calling prepareJob here, however
5050      * since the resilient queue sets the queue array values instead of the job
5051      * values directly, we duplicate the old prepareJob code here for the variables
5052      * needed
5053      */
5054     job->chapter_start = [fSrcChapterStartPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1;
5055     job->chapter_end = [fSrcChapterEndPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] + 1; 
5056     job->mux = [[fDstFormatPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5057     
5058     /* Audio goes here */
5059     int audiotrack_count = hb_list_count(job->list_audio);
5060     for( int i = 0; i < audiotrack_count;i++)
5061     {
5062         hb_audio_t * temp_audio = (hb_audio_t*) hb_list_item( job->list_audio, 0 );
5063         hb_list_rem(job->list_audio, temp_audio);
5064     }
5065     /* Now we need our audio info here for each track if applicable */
5066     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
5067     {
5068         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
5069         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
5070         audio->in.track = [fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5071         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
5072         audio->out.track = [fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5073         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5074         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5075         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5076         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5077         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack1DrcField floatValue];
5078         
5079         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
5080         free(audio);
5081     }  
5082     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
5083     {
5084         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
5085         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
5086         audio->in.track = [fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5087         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
5088         audio->out.track = [fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5089         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5090         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5091         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack2BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5092         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack2RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5093         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack2DrcField floatValue];
5094         
5095         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
5096         free(audio);
5097         
5098     }
5099     
5100     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
5101     {
5102         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
5103         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
5104         audio->in.track = [fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5105         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
5106         audio->out.track = [fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5107         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5108         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5109         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack3BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5110         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack3RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5111         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack3DrcField floatValue];
5112         
5113         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
5114         free(audio);
5115         
5116     }
5117
5118     if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
5119     {
5120         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) calloc(1, sizeof(*audio));
5121         hb_audio_config_init(audio);
5122         audio->in.track = [fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5123         /* We go ahead and assign values to our audio->out.<properties> */
5124         audio->out.track = [fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5125         audio->out.codec = [[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5126         audio->out.mixdown = [[fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5127         audio->out.bitrate = [[fAudTrack4BitratePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5128         audio->out.samplerate = [[fAudTrack4RatePopUp selectedItem] tag];
5129         audio->out.dynamic_range_compression = [fAudTrack4DrcField floatValue];
5130         
5131         hb_audio_add( job, audio );
5132         free(audio);
5133         
5134     }
5135        
5136 [fVidBitrateField setIntValue: hb_calc_bitrate( job, [fVidTargetSizeField intValue] )];
5137 }
5138
5139 #pragma mark -
5140 #pragma mark - Picture
5141
5142 /* lets set the picture size back to the max from right after title scan
5143    Lets use an IBAction here as down the road we could always use a checkbox
5144    in the gui to easily take the user back to max. Remember, the compiler
5145    resolves IBActions down to -(void) during compile anyway */
5146 - (IBAction) revertPictureSizeToMax: (id) sender
5147 {
5148         hb_job_t * job = fTitle->job;
5149         /* Here we apply the title source and height */
5150     job->width = fTitle->width;
5151     job->height = fTitle->height;
5152     
5153     [self calculatePictureSizing: sender];
5154     /* We call method to change UI to reflect whether a preset is used or not*/    
5155     [self customSettingUsed: sender];
5156 }
5157
5158 /**
5159  * Registers changes made in the Picture Settings Window.
5160  */
5161
5162 - (void)pictureSettingsDidChange 
5163 {
5164         [self calculatePictureSizing:nil];
5165 }
5166
5167 /* Get and Display Current Pic Settings in main window */
5168 - (IBAction) calculatePictureSizing: (id) sender
5169 {
5170         if (fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode > 0)
5171         {
5172         fTitle->job->keep_ratio = 0;
5173         }
5174     
5175     if (fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode != 1) // we are not strict so show the modulus
5176         {
5177         [fPictureSizeField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"Picture Size: %@, Modulus: %d", [fPictureController getPictureSizeInfoString], fTitle->job->modulus]];
5178     }
5179     else
5180     {
5181         [fPictureSizeField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"Picture Size: %@", [fPictureController getPictureSizeInfoString]]];
5182     }
5183     NSString *picCropping;
5184     /* Set the display field for crop as per boolean */
5185         if (![fPictureController autoCrop])
5186         {
5187         picCropping =  @"Custom";
5188         }
5189         else
5190         {
5191                 picCropping =  @"Auto";
5192         }
5193     picCropping = [picCropping stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" %d/%d/%d/%d",fTitle->job->crop[0],fTitle->job->crop[1],fTitle->job->crop[2],fTitle->job->crop[3]]];
5194     
5195     [fPictureCroppingField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"Picture Cropping: %@",picCropping]];
5196     
5197     NSString *videoFilters;
5198     videoFilters = @"";
5199     /* Detelecine */
5200     if ([fPictureController detelecine] == 2) 
5201     {
5202         videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Detelecine (Default)"];
5203     }
5204     else if ([fPictureController detelecine] == 1) 
5205     {
5206         videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" - Detelecine (%@)",[fPictureController detelecineCustomString]]];
5207     }
5208     
5209     
5210     if ([fPictureController useDecomb] == 1)
5211     {
5212         /* Decomb */
5213         if ([fPictureController decomb] == 2)
5214         {
5215             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Decomb (Default)"];
5216         }
5217         else if ([fPictureController decomb] == 1)
5218         {
5219             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" - Decomb (%@)",[fPictureController decombCustomString]]];
5220         }
5221     }
5222     else
5223     {
5224         /* Deinterlace */
5225         if ([fPictureController deinterlace] > 0)
5226         {
5227             fTitle->job->deinterlace  = 1;
5228         }
5229         else
5230         {
5231             fTitle->job->deinterlace  = 0;
5232         }
5233         
5234         if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 2)
5235         {
5236             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Deinterlace (Fast)"];
5237         }
5238         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 3)
5239         {
5240             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Deinterlace (Slow)"];
5241         }
5242         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 4)
5243         {
5244             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Deinterlace (Slower)"];
5245         }
5246         else if ([fPictureController deinterlace] == 1)
5247         {
5248             videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" - Deinterlace (%@)",[fPictureController deinterlaceCustomString]]];
5249         }
5250         }
5251     
5252     
5253     /* Denoise */
5254         if ([fPictureController denoise] == 2)
5255         {
5256                 videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Denoise (Weak)"];
5257     }
5258         else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 3)
5259         {
5260                 videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Denoise (Medium)"];
5261     }
5262         else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 4)
5263         {
5264                 videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Denoise (Strong)"];
5265         }
5266     else if ([fPictureController denoise] == 1)
5267         {
5268                 videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" - Denoise (%@)",[fPictureController denoiseCustomString]]];
5269         }
5270     
5271     /* Deblock */
5272     if ([fPictureController deblock] > 0) 
5273     {
5274         videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:[NSString stringWithFormat:@" - Deblock (%d)",[fPictureController deblock]]];
5275     }
5276         
5277     /* Grayscale */
5278     if ([fPictureController grayscale]) 
5279     {
5280         videoFilters = [videoFilters stringByAppendingString:@" - Grayscale"];
5281     }
5282     [fVideoFiltersField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat:@"Video Filters: %@", videoFilters]];
5283     
5284     //[fPictureController reloadStillPreview]; 
5285 }
5286
5287
5288 #pragma mark -
5289 #pragma mark - Audio and Subtitles
5290 - (IBAction) audioCodecsPopUpChanged: (id) sender
5291 {
5292     
5293     NSPopUpButton * audiotrackPopUp;
5294     NSPopUpButton * sampleratePopUp;
5295     NSPopUpButton * bitratePopUp;
5296     NSPopUpButton * audiocodecPopUp;
5297     if (sender == fAudTrack1CodecPopUp)
5298     {
5299         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang1PopUp;
5300         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack1CodecPopUp;
5301         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack1RatePopUp;
5302         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack1BitratePopUp;
5303     }
5304     else if (sender == fAudTrack2CodecPopUp)
5305     {
5306         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang2PopUp;
5307         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack2CodecPopUp;
5308         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack2RatePopUp;
5309         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack2BitratePopUp;
5310     }
5311     else if (sender == fAudTrack3CodecPopUp)
5312     {
5313         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang3PopUp;
5314         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack3CodecPopUp;
5315         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack3RatePopUp;
5316         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack3BitratePopUp;
5317     }
5318     else
5319     {
5320         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang4PopUp;
5321         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack4CodecPopUp;
5322         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack4RatePopUp;
5323         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack4BitratePopUp;
5324     }
5325         
5326     /* changing the codecs on offer may mean that we can / can't offer mono or 6ch, */
5327         /* so call audioTrackPopUpChanged for both audio tracks to update the mixdown popups */
5328     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: audiotrackPopUp];
5329     
5330 }
5331
5332 - (IBAction) setEnabledStateOfAudioMixdownControls: (id) sender
5333 {
5334     /* We will be setting the enabled/disabled state of each tracks audio controls based on
5335      * the settings of the source audio for that track. We leave the samplerate and bitrate
5336      * to audiotrackMixdownChanged
5337      */
5338     
5339     /* We will first verify that a lower track number has been selected before enabling each track
5340      * for example, make sure a track is selected for track 1 before enabling track 2, etc.
5341      */
5342     
5343     /* If the source has no audio then disable audio track 1 */
5344     if (hb_list_count( fTitle->list_audio ) == 0)
5345     {
5346         [fAudLang1PopUp selectItemAtIndex:0];
5347     }
5348      
5349     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5350     {
5351         [fAudLang2PopUp setEnabled: NO];
5352         [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
5353     }
5354     else
5355     {
5356         [fAudLang2PopUp setEnabled: YES];
5357     }
5358     
5359     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5360     {
5361         [fAudLang3PopUp setEnabled: NO];
5362         [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
5363     }
5364     else
5365     {
5366         [fAudLang3PopUp setEnabled: YES];
5367     }
5368     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5369     {
5370         [fAudLang4PopUp setEnabled: NO];
5371         [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
5372     }
5373     else
5374     {
5375         [fAudLang4PopUp setEnabled: YES];
5376     }
5377     /* enable/disable the mixdown text and popupbutton for audio track 1 */
5378     [fAudTrack1CodecPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5379     [fAudTrack1MixPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5380     [fAudTrack1RatePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5381     [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5382     [fAudTrack1DrcSlider setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5383     [fAudTrack1DrcField setEnabled: ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5384     if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5385     {
5386         [fAudTrack1CodecPopUp removeAllItems];
5387         [fAudTrack1MixPopUp removeAllItems];
5388         [fAudTrack1RatePopUp removeAllItems];
5389         [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp removeAllItems];
5390         [fAudTrack1DrcSlider setFloatValue: 0.00];
5391         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack1DrcSlider];
5392     }
5393     else if ([[fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5394     {
5395         [fAudTrack1RatePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5396         [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5397         [fAudTrack1DrcSlider setEnabled: NO];
5398         [fAudTrack1DrcField setEnabled: NO];
5399     }
5400     
5401     /* enable/disable the mixdown text and popupbutton for audio track 2 */
5402     [fAudTrack2CodecPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5403     [fAudTrack2MixPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5404     [fAudTrack2RatePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5405     [fAudTrack2BitratePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5406     [fAudTrack2DrcSlider setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5407     [fAudTrack2DrcField setEnabled: ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5408     if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5409     {
5410         [fAudTrack2CodecPopUp removeAllItems];
5411         [fAudTrack2MixPopUp removeAllItems];
5412         [fAudTrack2RatePopUp removeAllItems];
5413         [fAudTrack2BitratePopUp removeAllItems];
5414         [fAudTrack2DrcSlider setFloatValue: 0.00];
5415         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack2DrcSlider];
5416     }
5417     else if ([[fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5418     {
5419         [fAudTrack2RatePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5420         [fAudTrack2BitratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5421         [fAudTrack2DrcSlider setEnabled: NO];
5422         [fAudTrack2DrcField setEnabled: NO];
5423     }
5424     
5425     /* enable/disable the mixdown text and popupbutton for audio track 3 */
5426     [fAudTrack3CodecPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5427     [fAudTrack3MixPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5428     [fAudTrack3RatePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5429     [fAudTrack3BitratePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5430     [fAudTrack3DrcSlider setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5431     [fAudTrack3DrcField setEnabled: ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5432     if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5433     {
5434         [fAudTrack3CodecPopUp removeAllItems];
5435         [fAudTrack3MixPopUp removeAllItems];
5436         [fAudTrack3RatePopUp removeAllItems];
5437         [fAudTrack3BitratePopUp removeAllItems];
5438         [fAudTrack3DrcSlider setFloatValue: 0.00];
5439         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack3DrcSlider];
5440     }
5441     else if ([[fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5442     {
5443         [fAudTrack3RatePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5444         [fAudTrack3BitratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5445         [fAudTrack3DrcSlider setEnabled: NO];
5446         [fAudTrack3DrcField setEnabled: NO];
5447     }
5448     
5449     /* enable/disable the mixdown text and popupbutton for audio track 4 */
5450     [fAudTrack4CodecPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5451     [fAudTrack4MixPopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5452     [fAudTrack4RatePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5453     [fAudTrack4BitratePopUp setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5454     [fAudTrack4DrcSlider setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5455     [fAudTrack4DrcField setEnabled: ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) ? NO : YES];
5456     if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
5457     {
5458         [fAudTrack4CodecPopUp removeAllItems];
5459         [fAudTrack4MixPopUp removeAllItems];
5460         [fAudTrack4RatePopUp removeAllItems];
5461         [fAudTrack4BitratePopUp removeAllItems];
5462         [fAudTrack4DrcSlider setFloatValue: 0.00];
5463         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack4DrcSlider];
5464     }
5465     else if ([[fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5466     {
5467         [fAudTrack4RatePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5468         [fAudTrack4BitratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
5469         [fAudTrack4DrcSlider setEnabled: NO];
5470         [fAudTrack4DrcField setEnabled: NO];
5471     }
5472     
5473 }
5474
5475 - (IBAction) addAllAudioTracksToPopUp: (id) sender
5476 {
5477
5478     hb_list_t  * list  = hb_get_titles( fHandle );
5479     hb_title_t * title = (hb_title_t*)
5480         hb_list_item( list, [fSrcTitlePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] );
5481
5482         hb_audio_config_t * audio;
5483
5484     [sender removeAllItems];
5485     [sender addItemWithTitle: NSLocalizedString( @"None", @"" )];
5486     for( int i = 0; i < hb_list_count( title->list_audio ); i++ )
5487     {
5488         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) hb_list_audio_config_item( title->list_audio, i );
5489         [[sender menu] addItemWithTitle:
5490             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: audio->lang.description]
5491             action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5492     }
5493     [sender selectItemAtIndex: 0];
5494
5495 }
5496
5497 - (IBAction) selectAudioTrackInPopUp: (id) sender searchPrefixString: (NSString *) searchPrefixString selectIndexIfNotFound: (int) selectIndexIfNotFound
5498 {
5499
5500     /* this method can be used to find a language, or a language-and-source-format combination, by passing in the appropriate string */
5501     /* e.g. to find the first French track, pass in an NSString * of "Francais" */
5502     /* e.g. to find the first English 5.1 AC3 track, pass in an NSString * of "English (AC3) (5.1 ch)" */
5503     /* if no matching track is found, then selectIndexIfNotFound is used to choose which track to select instead */
5504     if (hb_list_count( fTitle->list_audio ) != 0)
5505     {
5506         if (searchPrefixString)
5507         {
5508             
5509             for( int i = 0; i < [sender numberOfItems]; i++ )
5510             {
5511                 /* Try to find the desired search string */
5512                 if ([[[sender itemAtIndex: i] title] hasPrefix:searchPrefixString])
5513                 {
5514                     [sender selectItemAtIndex: i];
5515                     return;
5516                 }
5517             }
5518             /* couldn't find the string, so select the requested "search string not found" item */
5519             /* index of 0 means select the "none" item */
5520             /* index of 1 means select the first audio track */
5521             [sender selectItemAtIndex: selectIndexIfNotFound];
5522         }
5523         else
5524         {
5525             /* if no search string is provided, then select the selectIndexIfNotFound item */
5526             [sender selectItemAtIndex: selectIndexIfNotFound];
5527         }
5528     }
5529     else
5530     {
5531         [sender selectItemAtIndex: 0];
5532     }
5533
5534 }
5535 - (IBAction) audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: (id)sender
5536 {
5537     int format = [fDstFormatPopUp indexOfSelectedItem];
5538     
5539     /* setup pointers to the appropriate popups for the correct track */
5540     NSPopUpButton * audiocodecPopUp;
5541     NSPopUpButton * audiotrackPopUp;
5542     if (sender == fAudTrack1CodecPopUp)
5543     {
5544         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang1PopUp;
5545         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack1CodecPopUp;
5546     }
5547     else if (sender == fAudTrack2CodecPopUp)
5548     {
5549         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang2PopUp;
5550         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack2CodecPopUp;
5551     }
5552     else if (sender == fAudTrack3CodecPopUp)
5553     {
5554         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang3PopUp;
5555         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack3CodecPopUp;
5556     }
5557     else
5558     {
5559         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang4PopUp;
5560         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack4CodecPopUp;
5561     }
5562     
5563     [audiocodecPopUp removeAllItems];
5564     /* Make sure "None" isnt selected in the source track */
5565     if ([audiotrackPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
5566     {
5567         [audiocodecPopUp setEnabled:YES];
5568         NSMenuItem *menuItem;
5569         /* We setup our appropriate popups for codecs and put the int value in the popup tag for easy retrieval */
5570         switch( format )
5571         {
5572             case 0:
5573                 /* MP4 */
5574                 // CA_AAC
5575                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5576                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_CA_AAC];
5577                 // FAAC
5578                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AAC (faac)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5579                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_FAAC];
5580                 // MP3
5581                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"MP3 (lame)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5582                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_LAME];
5583                 // AC3 Passthru
5584                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AC3 Passthru" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5585                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_AC3];
5586                 break;
5587                 
5588             case 1:
5589                 /* MKV */
5590                 // CA_AAC
5591                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5592                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_CA_AAC];
5593                 // FAAC
5594                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AAC (faac)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5595                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_FAAC];
5596                 // AC3 Passthru
5597                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"AC3 Passthru" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5598                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_AC3];
5599                 // DTS Passthru
5600                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"DTS Passthru" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5601                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_DCA];
5602                 // MP3
5603                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"MP3 (lame)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5604                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_LAME];
5605                 // Vorbis
5606                 menuItem = [[audiocodecPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:@"Vorbis (vorbis)" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5607                 [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_VORBIS];
5608                 break;
5609         }
5610         [audiocodecPopUp selectItemAtIndex:0];
5611     }
5612     else
5613     {
5614         [audiocodecPopUp setEnabled:NO];
5615     }
5616 }
5617
5618 - (IBAction) audioTrackPopUpChanged: (id) sender
5619 {
5620     /* utility function to call audioTrackPopUpChanged without passing in a mixdown-to-use */
5621     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: sender mixdownToUse: 0];
5622 }
5623
5624 - (IBAction) audioTrackPopUpChanged: (id) sender mixdownToUse: (int) mixdownToUse
5625 {
5626     
5627     /* make sure we have a selected title before continuing */
5628     if (fTitle == NULL) return;
5629     /* make sure we have a source audio track before continuing */
5630     if (hb_list_count( fTitle->list_audio ) == 0)
5631     {
5632         [sender selectItemAtIndex:0];
5633         return;
5634     }
5635     /* if the sender is the lanaguage popup and there is nothing in the codec popup, lets call
5636     * audioAddAudioTrackCodecs on the codec popup to populate it properly before moving on
5637     */
5638     if (sender == fAudLang1PopUp && [[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp menu] numberOfItems] == 0)
5639     {
5640         [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack1CodecPopUp];
5641     }
5642     if (sender == fAudLang2PopUp && [[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp menu] numberOfItems] == 0)
5643     {
5644         [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack2CodecPopUp];
5645     }
5646     if (sender == fAudLang3PopUp && [[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp menu] numberOfItems] == 0)
5647     {
5648         [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack3CodecPopUp];
5649     }
5650     if (sender == fAudLang4PopUp && [[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp menu] numberOfItems] == 0)
5651     {
5652         [self audioAddAudioTrackCodecs: fAudTrack4CodecPopUp];
5653     }
5654     
5655     /* Now lets make the sender the appropriate Audio Track popup from this point on */
5656     if (sender == fAudTrack1CodecPopUp || sender == fAudTrack1MixPopUp)
5657     {
5658         sender = fAudLang1PopUp;
5659     }
5660     if (sender == fAudTrack2CodecPopUp || sender == fAudTrack2MixPopUp)
5661     {
5662         sender = fAudLang2PopUp;
5663     }
5664     if (sender == fAudTrack3CodecPopUp || sender == fAudTrack3MixPopUp)
5665     {
5666         sender = fAudLang3PopUp;
5667     }
5668     if (sender == fAudTrack4CodecPopUp || sender == fAudTrack4MixPopUp)
5669     {
5670         sender = fAudLang4PopUp;
5671     }
5672     
5673     /* pointer to this track's mixdown, codec, sample rate and bitrate NSPopUpButton's */
5674     NSPopUpButton * mixdownPopUp;
5675     NSPopUpButton * audiocodecPopUp;
5676     NSPopUpButton * sampleratePopUp;
5677     NSPopUpButton * bitratePopUp;
5678     if (sender == fAudLang1PopUp)
5679     {
5680         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack1MixPopUp;
5681         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack1CodecPopUp;
5682         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack1RatePopUp;
5683         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack1BitratePopUp;
5684     }
5685     else if (sender == fAudLang2PopUp)
5686     {
5687         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack2MixPopUp;
5688         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack2CodecPopUp;
5689         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack2RatePopUp;
5690         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack2BitratePopUp;
5691     }
5692     else if (sender == fAudLang3PopUp)
5693     {
5694         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack3MixPopUp;
5695         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack3CodecPopUp;
5696         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack3RatePopUp;
5697         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack3BitratePopUp;
5698     }
5699     else
5700     {
5701         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack4MixPopUp;
5702         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack4CodecPopUp;
5703         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack4RatePopUp;
5704         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack4BitratePopUp;
5705     }
5706
5707     /* get the index of the selected audio Track*/
5708     int thisAudioIndex = [sender indexOfSelectedItem] - 1;
5709
5710     /* pointer for the hb_audio_s struct we will use later on */
5711     hb_audio_config_t * audio;
5712
5713     int acodec;
5714     /* check if the audio mixdown controls need their enabled state changing */
5715     [self setEnabledStateOfAudioMixdownControls:nil];
5716
5717     if (thisAudioIndex != -1)
5718     {
5719
5720         /* get the audio */
5721         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) hb_list_audio_config_item( fTitle->list_audio, thisAudioIndex );// Should "fTitle" be title and be setup ?
5722
5723         /* actually manipulate the proper mixdowns here */
5724         /* delete the previous audio mixdown options */
5725         [mixdownPopUp removeAllItems];
5726
5727         acodec = [[audiocodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5728
5729         if (audio != NULL)
5730         {
5731
5732             /* find out if our selected output audio codec supports mono and / or 6ch */
5733             /* audioCodecsSupportMono and audioCodecsSupport6Ch are the same for now,
5734              but this may change in the future, so they are separated for flexibility */
5735             int audioCodecsSupportMono = (audio->in.codec && acodec != HB_ACODEC_LAME);
5736             int audioCodecsSupport6Ch = (audio->in.codec && acodec != HB_ACODEC_LAME);
5737             
5738             /* check for AC-3 passthru */
5739             if (audio->in.codec == HB_ACODEC_AC3 && acodec == HB_ACODEC_AC3)
5740             {
5741                 
5742             NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5743                  [NSString stringWithUTF8String: "AC3 Passthru"]
5744                                                action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5745              [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_AC3];   
5746             }
5747             else if (audio->in.codec == HB_ACODEC_DCA && acodec == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5748             {
5749             NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5750                  [NSString stringWithUTF8String: "DTS Passthru"]
5751                                                action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5752              [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_DCA]; 
5753             }
5754             else
5755             {
5756                 
5757                 /* add the appropriate audio mixdown menuitems to the popupbutton */
5758                 /* in each case, we set the new menuitem's tag to be the amixdown value for that mixdown,
5759                  so that we can reference the mixdown later */
5760                 
5761                 /* keep a track of the min and max mixdowns we used, so we can select the best match later */
5762                 int minMixdownUsed = 0;
5763                 int maxMixdownUsed = 0;
5764                 
5765                 /* get the input channel layout without any lfe channels */
5766                 int layout = audio->in.channel_layout & HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_DISCRETE_NO_LFE_MASK;
5767                 
5768                 /* do we want to add a mono option? */
5769                 if (audioCodecsSupportMono == 1)
5770                 {
5771                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5772                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[0].human_readable_name]
5773                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5774                     [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_mixdowns[0].amixdown];
5775                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[0].amixdown;
5776                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[0].amixdown);
5777                 }
5778                 
5779                 /* do we want to add a stereo option? */
5780                 /* offer stereo if we have a mono source and non-mono-supporting codecs, as otherwise we won't have a mixdown at all */
5781                 /* also offer stereo if we have a stereo-or-better source */
5782                 if ((layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_MONO && audioCodecsSupportMono == 0) || layout >= HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO)
5783                 {
5784                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5785                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[1].human_readable_name]
5786                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5787                     [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_mixdowns[1].amixdown];
5788                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[1].amixdown;
5789                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[1].amixdown);
5790                 }
5791                 
5792                 /* do we want to add a dolby surround (DPL1) option? */
5793                 if (layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_3F1R || layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_3F2R || layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_DOLBY)
5794                 {
5795                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5796                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[2].human_readable_name]
5797                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5798                     [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_mixdowns[2].amixdown];
5799                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[2].amixdown;
5800                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[2].amixdown);
5801                 }
5802                 
5803                 /* do we want to add a dolby pro logic 2 (DPL2) option? */
5804                 if (layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_3F2R)
5805                 {
5806                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5807                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[3].human_readable_name]
5808                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5809                     [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_mixdowns[3].amixdown];
5810                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[3].amixdown;
5811                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[3].amixdown);
5812                 }
5813                 
5814                 /* do we want to add a 6-channel discrete option? */
5815                 if (audioCodecsSupport6Ch == 1 && layout == HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_3F2R && (audio->in.channel_layout & HB_INPUT_CH_LAYOUT_HAS_LFE))
5816                 {
5817                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5818                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[4].human_readable_name]
5819                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5820                     [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_mixdowns[4].amixdown];
5821                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[4].amixdown;
5822                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[4].amixdown);
5823                 }
5824                 
5825                 /* do we want to add an AC-3 passthrough option? */
5826                 if (audio->in.codec == HB_ACODEC_AC3 && acodec == HB_ACODEC_AC3) 
5827                 {
5828                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5829                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[5].human_readable_name]
5830                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5831                     [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_AC3];
5832                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[5].amixdown;
5833                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[5].amixdown);
5834                 }
5835                 
5836                 /* do we want to add a DTS Passthru option ? HB_ACODEC_DCA*/
5837                 if (audio->in.codec == HB_ACODEC_DCA && acodec == HB_ACODEC_DCA) 
5838                 {
5839                     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[mixdownPopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
5840                                             [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_mixdowns[5].human_readable_name]
5841                                                                           action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
5842                     [menuItem setTag: HB_ACODEC_DCA];
5843                     if (minMixdownUsed == 0) minMixdownUsed = hb_audio_mixdowns[5].amixdown;
5844                     maxMixdownUsed = MAX(maxMixdownUsed, hb_audio_mixdowns[5].amixdown);
5845                 }
5846                 
5847                 /* auto-select the best mixdown based on our saved mixdown preference */
5848                 
5849                 /* for now, this is hard-coded to a "best" mixdown of HB_AMIXDOWN_DOLBYPLII */
5850                 /* ultimately this should be a prefs option */
5851                 int useMixdown;
5852                 
5853                 /* if we passed in a mixdown to use - in order to load a preset - then try and use it */
5854                 if (mixdownToUse > 0)
5855                 {
5856                     useMixdown = mixdownToUse;
5857                 }
5858                 else
5859                 {
5860                     useMixdown = HB_AMIXDOWN_DOLBYPLII;
5861                 }
5862                 
5863                 /* if useMixdown > maxMixdownUsed, then use maxMixdownUsed */
5864                 if (useMixdown > maxMixdownUsed)
5865                 { 
5866                     useMixdown = maxMixdownUsed;
5867                 }
5868                 
5869                 /* if useMixdown < minMixdownUsed, then use minMixdownUsed */
5870                 if (useMixdown < minMixdownUsed)
5871                 { 
5872                     useMixdown = minMixdownUsed;
5873                 }
5874                 
5875                 /* select the (possibly-amended) preferred mixdown */
5876                 [mixdownPopUp selectItemWithTag: useMixdown];
5877
5878             }
5879             /* In the case of a source track that is not AC3 and the user tries to use AC3 Passthru (which does not work)
5880              * we force the Audio Codec choice back to a workable codec. We use CoreAudio aac for all containers.
5881              */
5882             if (audio->in.codec != HB_ACODEC_AC3 && [[audiocodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3)
5883             {
5884                 [audiocodecPopUp selectItemWithTag: HB_ACODEC_CA_AAC];
5885             }
5886             
5887             /* In the case of a source track that is not DTS and the user tries to use DTS Passthru (which does not work)
5888              * we force the Audio Codec choice back to a workable codec. We use CoreAudio aac for all containers.
5889              */
5890             if (audio->in.codec != HB_ACODEC_DCA && [[audiocodecPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
5891             {
5892                 [audiocodecPopUp selectItemWithTag: HB_ACODEC_CA_AAC];
5893             }
5894             
5895             /* Setup our samplerate and bitrate popups we will need based on mixdown */
5896             [self audioTrackMixdownChanged: mixdownPopUp];             
5897         }
5898     
5899     }
5900     if( [fDstFormatPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0 )
5901     {
5902         [self autoSetM4vExtension: sender];
5903     }
5904 }
5905
5906 - (IBAction) audioTrackMixdownChanged: (id) sender
5907 {
5908     
5909     int acodec;
5910     /* setup pointers to all of the other audio track controls
5911     * we will need later
5912     */
5913     NSPopUpButton * mixdownPopUp;
5914     NSPopUpButton * sampleratePopUp;
5915     NSPopUpButton * bitratePopUp;
5916     NSPopUpButton * audiocodecPopUp;
5917     NSPopUpButton * audiotrackPopUp;
5918     NSSlider * drcSlider;
5919     NSTextField * drcField;
5920     if (sender == fAudTrack1MixPopUp)
5921     {
5922         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang1PopUp;
5923         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack1CodecPopUp;
5924         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack1MixPopUp;
5925         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack1RatePopUp;
5926         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack1BitratePopUp;
5927         drcSlider = fAudTrack1DrcSlider;
5928         drcField = fAudTrack1DrcField;
5929     }
5930     else if (sender == fAudTrack2MixPopUp)
5931     {
5932         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang2PopUp;
5933         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack2CodecPopUp;
5934         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack2MixPopUp;
5935         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack2RatePopUp;
5936         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack2BitratePopUp;
5937         drcSlider = fAudTrack2DrcSlider;
5938         drcField = fAudTrack2DrcField;
5939     }
5940     else if (sender == fAudTrack3MixPopUp)
5941     {
5942         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang3PopUp;
5943         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack3CodecPopUp;
5944         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack3MixPopUp;
5945         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack3RatePopUp;
5946         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack3BitratePopUp;
5947         drcSlider = fAudTrack3DrcSlider;
5948         drcField = fAudTrack3DrcField;
5949     }
5950     else
5951     {
5952         audiotrackPopUp = fAudLang4PopUp;
5953         audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack4CodecPopUp;
5954         mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack4MixPopUp;
5955         sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack4RatePopUp;
5956         bitratePopUp = fAudTrack4BitratePopUp;
5957         drcSlider = fAudTrack4DrcSlider;
5958         drcField = fAudTrack4DrcField;
5959     }
5960     acodec = [[audiocodecPopUp selectedItem] tag];
5961     /* storage variable for the min and max bitrate allowed for this codec */
5962     int minbitrate;
5963     int maxbitrate;
5964     
5965     switch( acodec )
5966     {
5967         case HB_ACODEC_FAAC:
5968             /* check if we have a 6ch discrete conversion in either audio track */
5969             if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_AMIXDOWN_6CH)
5970             {
5971                 /* FAAC has a minimum of 192 kbps for 6-channel discrete */
5972                 minbitrate = 192;
5973                 /* If either mixdown popup includes 6-channel discrete, then allow up to 448 kbps */
5974                 maxbitrate = 448;
5975                 break;
5976             }
5977             else
5978             {
5979                 /* FAAC is happy using our min bitrate of 32 kbps for stereo or mono */
5980                 minbitrate = 32;
5981                 /* FAAC won't honour anything more than 160 for stereo, so let's not offer it */
5982                 /* note: haven't dealt with mono separately here, FAAC will just use the max it can */
5983                 maxbitrate = 160;
5984                 break;
5985             }
5986
5987         case HB_ACODEC_CA_AAC:
5988             /* check if we have a 6ch discrete conversion in either audio track */
5989             if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_AMIXDOWN_6CH)
5990             {
5991                 minbitrate = 128;
5992                 maxbitrate = 768;
5993                 break;
5994             }
5995             else
5996             {
5997                 minbitrate = 64;
5998                 maxbitrate = 320;
5999                 break;
6000             }
6001
6002             case HB_ACODEC_LAME:
6003             /* Lame is happy using our min bitrate of 32 kbps */
6004             minbitrate = 32;
6005             /* Lame won't encode if the bitrate is higher than 320 kbps */
6006             maxbitrate = 320;
6007             break;
6008             
6009             case HB_ACODEC_VORBIS:
6010             if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_AMIXDOWN_6CH)
6011             {
6012                 /* Vorbis causes a crash if we use a bitrate below 192 kbps with 6 channel */
6013                 minbitrate = 192;
6014                 /* If either mixdown popup includes 6-channel discrete, then allow up to 384 kbps */
6015                 maxbitrate = 384;
6016                 break;
6017             }
6018             else
6019             {
6020                 /* Vorbis causes a crash if we use a bitrate below 48 kbps */
6021                 minbitrate = 48;
6022                 /* Vorbis can cope with 384 kbps quite happily, even for stereo */
6023                 maxbitrate = 384;
6024                 break;
6025             }
6026             
6027             default:
6028             /* AC3 passthru disables the bitrate dropdown anyway, so we might as well just use the min and max bitrate */
6029             minbitrate = 32;
6030             maxbitrate = 384;
6031             
6032     }
6033     
6034     /* make sure we have a selected title before continuing */
6035     if (fTitle == NULL || hb_list_count( fTitle->list_audio ) == 0) return;
6036     /* get the audio so we can find out what input rates are*/
6037     hb_audio_config_t * audio;
6038     audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) hb_list_audio_config_item( fTitle->list_audio, [audiotrackPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1 );
6039     int inputbitrate = audio->in.bitrate / 1000;
6040     int inputsamplerate = audio->in.samplerate;
6041     
6042     if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] != HB_ACODEC_AC3 && [[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] != HB_ACODEC_DCA)
6043     {
6044         [bitratePopUp removeAllItems];
6045         
6046         for( int i = 0; i < hb_audio_bitrates_count; i++ )
6047         {
6048             if (hb_audio_bitrates[i].rate >= minbitrate && hb_audio_bitrates[i].rate <= maxbitrate)
6049             {
6050                 /* add a new menuitem for this bitrate */
6051                 NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[bitratePopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
6052                                         [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_bitrates[i].string]
6053                                                                       action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
6054                 /* set its tag to be the actual bitrate as an integer, so we can retrieve it later */
6055                 [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_bitrates[i].rate];
6056             }
6057         }
6058         
6059         /* select the default bitrate (but use 384 for 6-ch AAC) */
6060         if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_AMIXDOWN_6CH)
6061         {
6062             [bitratePopUp selectItemWithTag: 384];
6063         }
6064         else
6065         {
6066             [bitratePopUp selectItemWithTag: hb_audio_bitrates[hb_audio_bitrates_default].rate];
6067         }
6068     }
6069     /* populate and set the sample rate popup */
6070     /* Audio samplerate */
6071     [sampleratePopUp removeAllItems];
6072     /* we create a same as source selection (Auto) so that we can choose to use the input sample rate */
6073     NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[sampleratePopUp menu] addItemWithTitle: @"Auto" action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
6074     [menuItem setTag: inputsamplerate];
6075     
6076     for( int i = 0; i < hb_audio_rates_count; i++ )
6077     {
6078         NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[sampleratePopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
6079                                 [NSString stringWithUTF8String: hb_audio_rates[i].string]
6080                                                                  action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
6081         [menuItem setTag: hb_audio_rates[i].rate];
6082     }
6083     /* We use the input sample rate as the default sample rate as downsampling just makes audio worse
6084     * and there is no compelling reason to use anything else as default, though the users default
6085     * preset will likely override any setting chosen here.
6086     */
6087     [sampleratePopUp selectItemWithTag: inputsamplerate];
6088     
6089     
6090     /* Since AC3 Pass Thru and DTS Pass Thru uses the input bitrate and sample rate, we get the input tracks
6091     * bitrate and display it in the bitrate popup even though libhb happily ignores any bitrate input from
6092     * the gui. We do this for better user feedback in the audio tab as well as the queue for the most part
6093     */
6094     if ([[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_AC3 || [[mixdownPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_ACODEC_DCA)
6095     {
6096         
6097         /* lets also set the bitrate popup to the input bitrate as thats what passthru will use */
6098         [bitratePopUp removeAllItems];
6099         NSMenuItem *menuItem = [[bitratePopUp menu] addItemWithTitle:
6100                                 [NSString stringWithFormat:@"%d", inputbitrate]
6101                                                               action: NULL keyEquivalent: @""];
6102         [menuItem setTag: inputbitrate];
6103         /* For ac3 passthru we disable the sample rate and bitrate popups as well as the drc slider*/
6104         [bitratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
6105         [sampleratePopUp setEnabled: NO];
6106         
6107         [drcSlider setFloatValue: 0.00];
6108         [self audioDRCSliderChanged: drcSlider];
6109         [drcSlider setEnabled: NO];
6110         [drcField setEnabled: NO];
6111     }
6112     else
6113     {
6114         [sampleratePopUp setEnabled: YES];
6115         [bitratePopUp setEnabled: YES];
6116         [drcSlider setEnabled: YES];
6117         [drcField setEnabled: YES];
6118     }
6119 [self calculateBitrate:nil];    
6120 }
6121
6122 - (IBAction) audioDRCSliderChanged: (id) sender
6123 {
6124     NSSlider * drcSlider;
6125     NSTextField * drcField;
6126     if (sender == fAudTrack1DrcSlider)
6127     {
6128         drcSlider = fAudTrack1DrcSlider;
6129         drcField = fAudTrack1DrcField;
6130     }
6131     else if (sender == fAudTrack2DrcSlider)
6132     {
6133         drcSlider = fAudTrack2DrcSlider;
6134         drcField = fAudTrack2DrcField;
6135     }
6136     else if (sender == fAudTrack3DrcSlider)
6137     {
6138         drcSlider = fAudTrack3DrcSlider;
6139         drcField = fAudTrack3DrcField;
6140     }
6141     else
6142     {
6143         drcSlider = fAudTrack4DrcSlider;
6144         drcField = fAudTrack4DrcField;
6145     }
6146     
6147     /* If we are between 0.0 and 1.0 on the slider, snap it to 1.0 */
6148     if ([drcSlider floatValue] > 0.0 && [drcSlider floatValue] < 1.0)
6149     {
6150         [drcSlider setFloatValue:1.0];
6151     }
6152     
6153     
6154     [drcField setStringValue: [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%.2f", [drcSlider floatValue]]];
6155     /* For now, do not call this until we have an intelligent way to determine audio track selections
6156     * compared to presets
6157     */
6158     //[self customSettingUsed: sender];
6159 }
6160
6161 #pragma mark -
6162
6163 - (IBAction) browseImportSrtFile: (id) sender
6164 {
6165
6166     NSOpenPanel * panel;
6167         
6168     panel = [NSOpenPanel openPanel];
6169     [panel setAllowsMultipleSelection: NO];
6170     [panel setCanChooseFiles: YES];
6171     [panel setCanChooseDirectories: NO ];
6172     NSString * sourceDirectory;
6173         if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastSrtImportDirectory"])
6174         {
6175                 sourceDirectory = [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastSrtImportDirectory"];
6176         }
6177         else
6178         {
6179                 sourceDirectory = @"~/Desktop";
6180                 sourceDirectory = [sourceDirectory stringByExpandingTildeInPath];
6181         }
6182     /* we open up the browse srt sheet here and call for browseImportSrtFileDone after the sheet is closed */
6183     NSArray *fileTypes = [NSArray arrayWithObjects:@"plist", @"srt", nil];
6184     [panel beginSheetForDirectory: sourceDirectory file: nil types: fileTypes
6185                    modalForWindow: fWindow modalDelegate: self
6186                    didEndSelector: @selector( browseImportSrtFileDone:returnCode:contextInfo: )
6187                       contextInfo: sender];
6188 }
6189
6190 - (void) browseImportSrtFileDone: (NSSavePanel *) sheet
6191                      returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
6192 {
6193     if( returnCode == NSOKButton )
6194     {
6195         NSString *importSrtDirectory = [[sheet filename] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
6196         NSString *importSrtFilePath = [sheet filename];
6197         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:importSrtDirectory forKey:@"LastSrtImportDirectory"];
6198         
6199         /* now pass the string off to fSubtitlesDelegate to add the srt file to the dropdown */
6200         [fSubtitlesDelegate createSubtitleSrtTrack:importSrtFilePath];
6201         
6202         [fSubtitlesTable reloadData];
6203         
6204     }
6205 }                                           
6206
6207 #pragma mark -
6208 #pragma mark Open New Windows
6209
6210 - (IBAction) openHomepage: (id) sender
6211 {
6212     [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL: [NSURL
6213         URLWithString:@"http://handbrake.fr/"]];
6214 }
6215
6216 - (IBAction) openForums: (id) sender
6217 {
6218     [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL: [NSURL
6219         URLWithString:@"http://handbrake.fr/forum/"]];
6220 }
6221 - (IBAction) openUserGuide: (id) sender
6222 {
6223     [[NSWorkspace sharedWorkspace] openURL: [NSURL
6224         URLWithString:@"http://handbrake.fr/trac/wiki/HandBrakeGuide"]];
6225 }
6226
6227 /**
6228  * Shows debug output window.
6229  */
6230 - (IBAction)showDebugOutputPanel:(id)sender
6231 {
6232     [outputPanel showOutputPanel:sender];
6233 }
6234
6235 /**
6236  * Shows preferences window.
6237  */
6238 - (IBAction) showPreferencesWindow: (id) sender
6239 {
6240     NSWindow * window = [fPreferencesController window];
6241     if (![window isVisible])
6242         [window center];
6243
6244     [window makeKeyAndOrderFront: nil];
6245 }
6246
6247 /**
6248  * Shows queue window.
6249  */
6250 - (IBAction) showQueueWindow:(id)sender
6251 {
6252     [fQueueController showQueueWindow:sender];
6253 }
6254
6255
6256 - (IBAction) toggleDrawer:(id)sender {
6257     [fPresetDrawer toggle:self];
6258 }
6259
6260 /**
6261  * Shows Picture Settings Window.
6262  */
6263
6264 - (IBAction) showPicturePanel: (id) sender
6265 {
6266         [fPictureController showPictureWindow:sender];
6267 }
6268
6269 - (void) picturePanelFullScreen
6270 {
6271         [fPictureController setToFullScreenMode];
6272 }
6273
6274 - (void) picturePanelWindowed
6275 {
6276         [fPictureController setToWindowedMode];
6277 }
6278
6279 - (IBAction) showPreviewWindow: (id) sender
6280 {
6281         [fPictureController showPreviewWindow:sender];
6282 }
6283
6284 #pragma mark -
6285 #pragma mark Preset Outline View Methods
6286 #pragma mark - Required
6287 /* These are required by the NSOutlineView Datasource Delegate */
6288
6289
6290 /* used to specify the number of levels to show for each item */
6291 - (int)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)fPresetsOutlineView numberOfChildrenOfItem:(id)item
6292 {
6293     /* currently use no levels to test outline view viability */
6294     if (item == nil) // for an outline view the root level of the hierarchy is always nil
6295     {
6296         return [UserPresets count];
6297     }
6298     else
6299     {
6300         /* we need to return the count of the array in ChildrenArray for this folder */
6301         NSArray *children = nil;
6302         children = [item objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
6303         if ([children count] > 0)
6304         {
6305             return [children count];
6306         }
6307         else
6308         {
6309             return 0;
6310         }
6311     }
6312 }
6313
6314 /* We use this to deterimine children of an item */
6315 - (id)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)fPresetsOutlineView child:(NSInteger)index ofItem:(id)item
6316 {
6317     
6318     /* we need to return the count of the array in ChildrenArray for this folder */
6319     NSArray *children = nil;
6320     if (item == nil)
6321     {
6322         children = UserPresets;
6323     }
6324     else
6325     {
6326         if ([item objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
6327         {
6328             children = [item objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
6329         }
6330     }   
6331     if ((children == nil) || ( [children count] <= (NSUInteger) index))
6332     {
6333         return nil;
6334     }
6335     else
6336     {
6337         return [children objectAtIndex:index];
6338     }
6339     
6340     
6341     // We are only one level deep, so we can't be asked about children
6342     //NSAssert (NO, @"Presets View outlineView:child:ofItem: currently can't handle nested items.");
6343     //return nil;
6344 }
6345
6346 /* We use this to determine if an item should be expandable */
6347 - (BOOL)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)fPresetsOutlineView isItemExpandable:(id)item
6348 {
6349     
6350     /* we need to return the count of the array in ChildrenArray for this folder */
6351     NSArray *children= nil;
6352     if (item == nil)
6353     {
6354         children = UserPresets;
6355     }
6356     else
6357     {
6358         if ([item objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
6359         {
6360             children = [item objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
6361         }
6362     }   
6363     
6364     /* To deterimine if an item should show a disclosure triangle
6365      * we could do it by the children count as so:
6366      * if ([children count] < 1)
6367      * However, lets leave the triangle show even if there are no
6368      * children to help indicate a folder, just like folder in the
6369      * finder can show a disclosure triangle even when empty
6370      */
6371     
6372     /* We need to determine if the item is a folder */
6373    if ([[item objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] == 1)
6374    {
6375         return YES;
6376     }
6377     else
6378     {
6379         return NO;
6380     }
6381     
6382 }
6383
6384 - (BOOL)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView shouldExpandItem:(id)item
6385 {
6386     // Our outline view has no levels, but we can still expand every item. Doing so
6387     // just makes the row taller. See heightOfRowByItem below.
6388 //return ![(HBQueueOutlineView*)outlineView isDragging];
6389
6390 return YES;
6391 }
6392
6393
6394 /* Used to tell the outline view which information is to be displayed per item */
6395 - (id)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)fPresetsOutlineView objectValueForTableColumn:(NSTableColumn *)tableColumn byItem:(id)item
6396 {
6397         /* We have two columns right now, icon and PresetName */
6398         
6399     if ([[tableColumn identifier] isEqualToString:@"PresetName"])
6400     {
6401         return [item objectForKey:@"PresetName"];
6402     }
6403     else
6404     {
6405         //return @"";
6406         return nil;
6407     }
6408 }
6409
6410 - (id)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView itemForPersistentObject:(id)object
6411 {
6412     return [NSKeyedUnarchiver unarchiveObjectWithData:object];
6413 }
6414 - (id)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView persistentObjectForItem:(id)item
6415 {
6416     return [NSKeyedArchiver archivedDataWithRootObject:item];
6417 }
6418
6419 #pragma mark - Added Functionality (optional)
6420 /* Use to customize the font and display characteristics of the title cell */
6421 - (void)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView willDisplayCell:(id)cell forTableColumn:(NSTableColumn *)tableColumn item:(id)item
6422 {
6423     if ([[tableColumn identifier] isEqualToString:@"PresetName"])
6424     {
6425         NSFont *txtFont;
6426         NSColor *fontColor;
6427         NSColor *shadowColor;
6428         txtFont = [NSFont systemFontOfSize: [NSFont smallSystemFontSize]];
6429         /*check to see if its a selected row */
6430         if ([fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow] == [fPresetsOutlineView rowForItem:item])
6431         {
6432             
6433             fontColor = [NSColor blackColor];
6434             shadowColor = [NSColor colorWithDeviceRed:(127.0/255.0) green:(140.0/255.0) blue:(160.0/255.0) alpha:1.0];
6435         }
6436         else
6437         {
6438             if ([[item objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0)
6439             {
6440                 fontColor = [NSColor blueColor];
6441             }
6442             else // User created preset, use a black font
6443             {
6444                 fontColor = [NSColor blackColor];
6445             }
6446             /* check to see if its a folder */
6447             //if ([[item objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] == 1)
6448             //{
6449             //fontColor = [NSColor greenColor];
6450             //}
6451             
6452             
6453         }
6454         /* We use Bold Text for the HB Default */
6455         if ([[item objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 1)// 1 is HB default
6456         {
6457             txtFont = [NSFont boldSystemFontOfSize: [NSFont smallSystemFontSize]];
6458         }
6459         /* We use Bold Text for the User Specified Default */
6460         if ([[item objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 2)// 2 is User default
6461         {
6462             txtFont = [NSFont boldSystemFontOfSize: [NSFont smallSystemFontSize]];
6463         }
6464         
6465         
6466         [cell setTextColor:fontColor];
6467         [cell setFont:txtFont];
6468         
6469     }
6470 }
6471
6472 /* We use this to edit the name field in the outline view */
6473 - (void)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView setObjectValue:(id)object forTableColumn:(NSTableColumn *)tableColumn byItem:(id)item
6474 {
6475     if ([[tableColumn identifier] isEqualToString:@"PresetName"])
6476     {
6477         id theRecord;
6478         
6479         theRecord = item;
6480         [theRecord setObject:object forKey:@"PresetName"];
6481         
6482         [self sortPresets];
6483         
6484         [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
6485         /* We save all of the preset data here */
6486         [self savePreset];
6487     }
6488 }
6489 /* We use this to provide tooltips for the items in the presets outline view */
6490 - (NSString *)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)fPresetsOutlineView toolTipForCell:(NSCell *)cell rect:(NSRectPointer)rect tableColumn:(NSTableColumn *)tc item:(id)item mouseLocation:(NSPoint)mouseLocation
6491 {
6492     //if ([[tc identifier] isEqualToString:@"PresetName"])
6493     //{
6494         /* initialize the tooltip contents variable */
6495         NSString *loc_tip;
6496         /* if there is a description for the preset, we show it in the tooltip */
6497         if ([item objectForKey:@"PresetDescription"])
6498         {
6499             loc_tip = [item objectForKey:@"PresetDescription"];
6500             return (loc_tip);
6501         }
6502         else
6503         {
6504             loc_tip = @"No description available";
6505         }
6506         return (loc_tip);
6507     //}
6508 }
6509
6510 #pragma mark -
6511 #pragma mark Preset Outline View Methods (dragging related)
6512
6513
6514 - (BOOL)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView writeItems:(NSArray *)items toPasteboard:(NSPasteboard *)pboard
6515 {
6516         // Dragging is only allowed for custom presets.
6517     //[[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] != 1
6518         if ([[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0) // 0 is built in preset
6519     {
6520         return NO;
6521     }
6522     // Don't retain since this is just holding temporaral drag information, and it is
6523     //only used during a drag!  We could put this in the pboard actually.
6524     fDraggedNodes = items;
6525     // Provide data for our custom type, and simple NSStrings.
6526     [pboard declareTypes:[NSArray arrayWithObjects: DragDropSimplePboardType, nil] owner:self];
6527     
6528     // the actual data doesn't matter since DragDropSimplePboardType drags aren't recognized by anyone but us!.
6529     [pboard setData:[NSData data] forType:DragDropSimplePboardType]; 
6530     
6531     return YES;
6532 }
6533
6534 - (NSDragOperation)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView validateDrop:(id <NSDraggingInfo>)info proposedItem:(id)item proposedChildIndex:(NSInteger)index
6535 {
6536         
6537         // Don't allow dropping ONTO an item since they can't really contain any children.
6538     
6539     BOOL isOnDropTypeProposal = index == NSOutlineViewDropOnItemIndex;
6540     if (isOnDropTypeProposal)
6541         return NSDragOperationNone;
6542     
6543     // Don't allow dropping INTO an item since they can't really contain any children as of yet.
6544         if (item != nil)
6545         {
6546                 index = [fPresetsOutlineView rowForItem: item] + 1;
6547                 item = nil;
6548         }
6549     
6550     // Don't allow dropping into the Built In Presets.
6551     if (index < presetCurrentBuiltInCount)
6552     {
6553         return NSDragOperationNone;
6554         index = MAX (index, presetCurrentBuiltInCount);
6555         }    
6556         
6557     [outlineView setDropItem:item dropChildIndex:index];
6558     return NSDragOperationGeneric;
6559 }
6560
6561
6562
6563 - (BOOL)outlineView:(NSOutlineView *)outlineView acceptDrop:(id <NSDraggingInfo>)info item:(id)item childIndex:(NSInteger)index
6564 {
6565     /* first, lets see if we are dropping into a folder */
6566     if ([[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:index] objectForKey:@"Folder"] && [[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:index] objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] == 1) // if its a folder
6567         {
6568     NSMutableArray *childrenArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
6569     childrenArray = [[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:index] objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
6570     [childrenArray addObject:item];
6571     [[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:index] setObject:[NSMutableArray arrayWithArray: childrenArray] forKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
6572     [childrenArray autorelease];
6573     }
6574     else // We are not, so we just move the preset into the existing array 
6575     {
6576         NSMutableIndexSet *moveItems = [NSMutableIndexSet indexSet];
6577         id obj;
6578         NSEnumerator *enumerator = [fDraggedNodes objectEnumerator];
6579         while (obj = [enumerator nextObject])
6580         {
6581             [moveItems addIndex:[UserPresets indexOfObject:obj]];
6582         }
6583         // Successful drop, lets rearrange the view and save it all
6584         [self moveObjectsInPresetsArray:UserPresets fromIndexes:moveItems toIndex: index];
6585     }
6586     [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
6587     [self savePreset];
6588     return YES;
6589 }
6590
6591 - (void)moveObjectsInPresetsArray:(NSMutableArray *)array fromIndexes:(NSIndexSet *)indexSet toIndex:(NSUInteger)insertIndex
6592 {
6593     NSUInteger index = [indexSet lastIndex];
6594     NSUInteger aboveInsertIndexCount = 0;
6595     
6596     NSUInteger removeIndex;
6597
6598     if (index >= insertIndex)
6599     {
6600         removeIndex = index + aboveInsertIndexCount;
6601         aboveInsertIndexCount++;
6602     }
6603     else
6604     {
6605         removeIndex = index;
6606         insertIndex--;
6607     }
6608
6609     id object = [[array objectAtIndex:removeIndex] retain];
6610     [array removeObjectAtIndex:removeIndex];
6611     [array insertObject:object atIndex:insertIndex];
6612     [object release];
6613
6614     index = [indexSet indexLessThanIndex:index];
6615 }
6616
6617
6618
6619 #pragma mark - Functional Preset NSOutlineView Methods
6620
6621 - (IBAction)selectPreset:(id)sender
6622 {
6623     
6624     if ([fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow] >= 0 && [[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] != 1)
6625     {
6626         chosenPreset = [fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
6627         [fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PresetName"]];
6628         
6629         if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 1)
6630         {
6631             [fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue:[NSString stringWithFormat:@"%@ (Default)", [chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PresetName"]]];
6632         }
6633         else
6634         {
6635             [fPresetSelectedDisplay setStringValue:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PresetName"]];
6636         }
6637         
6638         /* File Format */
6639         [fDstFormatPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"FileFormat"]];
6640         [self formatPopUpChanged:nil];
6641         
6642         /* Chapter Markers*/
6643         [fCreateChapterMarkers setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"ChapterMarkers"] intValue]];
6644         /* check to see if we have only one chapter */
6645         [self chapterPopUpChanged:nil];
6646         
6647         /* Allow Mpeg4 64 bit formatting +4GB file sizes */
6648         [fDstMp4LargeFileCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Mp4LargeFile"] intValue]];
6649         /* Mux mp4 with http optimization */
6650         [fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Mp4HttpOptimize"] intValue]];
6651         
6652         /* Video encoder */
6653         [fVidEncoderPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoEncoder"]];
6654         /* We set the advanced opt string here if applicable*/
6655         [fAdvancedOptions setOptions:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"x264Option"]];
6656         
6657         /* Lets run through the following functions to get variables set there */
6658         [self videoEncoderPopUpChanged:nil];
6659         /* Set the state of ipod compatible with Mp4iPodCompatible. Only for x264*/
6660         [fDstMp4iPodFileCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Mp4iPodCompatible"] intValue]];
6661         [self calculateBitrate:nil];
6662         
6663         /* Video quality */
6664         [fVidQualityMatrix selectCellAtRow:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoQualityType"] intValue] column:0];
6665         
6666         [fVidTargetSizeField setStringValue:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoTargetSize"]];
6667         [fVidBitrateField setStringValue:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoAvgBitrate"]];
6668         
6669         /* Since we are now using RF Values for the slider, we detect if the preset uses an old quality float.
6670          * So, check to see if the quality value is less than 1.0 which should indicate the old ".062" type
6671          * quality preset. Caveat: in the case of x264, where the RF scale starts at 0, it would misinterpret
6672          * a preset that uses 0.0 - 0.99 for RF as an old style preset. Not sure how to get around that one yet,
6673          * though it should be a corner case since it would pretty much be a preset for lossless encoding. */
6674         if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue] < 1.0)
6675         {
6676             /* For the quality slider we need to convert the old percent's to the new rf scales */
6677             float rf =  (([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] - [fVidQualitySlider minValue]) * [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]);
6678             [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:rf];
6679             
6680         }
6681         else
6682         {
6683             /* Since theora's qp value goes up from left to right, we can just set the slider float value */
6684             if ([[fVidEncoderPopUp selectedItem] tag] == HB_VCODEC_THEORA)
6685             {
6686                 [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]];
6687             }
6688             else
6689             {
6690                 /* since ffmpeg and x264 use an "inverted" slider (lower qp/rf values indicate a higher quality) we invert the value on the slider */
6691                 [fVidQualitySlider setFloatValue:([fVidQualitySlider maxValue] + [fVidQualitySlider minValue]) - [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"] floatValue]];
6692             }
6693         }
6694         
6695         [self videoMatrixChanged:nil];
6696         
6697         /* Video framerate */
6698         /* For video preset video framerate, we want to make sure that Same as source does not conflict with the
6699          detected framerate in the fVidRatePopUp so we use index 0*/
6700         if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoFramerate"] isEqualToString:@"Same as source"])
6701         {
6702             [fVidRatePopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
6703         }
6704         else
6705         {
6706             [fVidRatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoFramerate"]];
6707         }
6708         
6709         
6710         /* 2 Pass Encoding */
6711         [fVidTwoPassCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoTwoPass"] intValue]];
6712         [self twoPassCheckboxChanged:nil];
6713         
6714         /* Turbo 1st pass for 2 Pass Encoding */
6715         [fVidTurboPassCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoTurboTwoPass"] intValue]];
6716         
6717         /*Audio*/
6718         /* First we check to see if we are using the current audio track layout based on AudioList array */
6719         if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"AudioList"])
6720         {
6721             
6722             /* pointer to this track's mixdown, codec, sample rate and bitrate NSPopUpButton's */
6723             NSPopUpButton * trackLangPreviousPopUp = nil;
6724             NSPopUpButton * trackLangPopUp = nil;
6725             NSPopUpButton * mixdownPopUp = nil;
6726             NSPopUpButton * audiocodecPopUp = nil;
6727             NSPopUpButton * sampleratePopUp = nil;
6728             NSPopUpButton * bitratePopUp = nil;
6729             NSSlider      * drcSlider = nil;
6730             
6731             
6732             /* Populate the audio widgets based on the contents of the AudioList array */
6733             int i = 0;
6734             NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"AudioList"] objectEnumerator];
6735             id tempObject;
6736             while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
6737             {
6738                 i++;
6739                 if( i == 1 )
6740                 {
6741                     trackLangPopUp = fAudLang1PopUp;
6742                     mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack1MixPopUp;
6743                     audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack1CodecPopUp;
6744                     sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack1RatePopUp;
6745                     bitratePopUp = fAudTrack1BitratePopUp;
6746                     drcSlider = fAudTrack1DrcSlider;
6747                 }
6748                 if( i == 2 )
6749                 {
6750                     trackLangPreviousPopUp = fAudLang1PopUp;
6751                     trackLangPopUp = fAudLang2PopUp;
6752                     mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack2MixPopUp;
6753                     audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack2CodecPopUp;
6754                     sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack2RatePopUp;
6755                     bitratePopUp = fAudTrack2BitratePopUp;
6756                     drcSlider = fAudTrack2DrcSlider;
6757                 }
6758                 if( i == 3 )
6759                 {
6760                     trackLangPreviousPopUp = fAudLang2PopUp;
6761                     trackLangPopUp = fAudLang3PopUp;
6762                     mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack3MixPopUp;
6763                     audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack3CodecPopUp;
6764                     sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack3RatePopUp;
6765                     bitratePopUp = fAudTrack3BitratePopUp;
6766                     drcSlider = fAudTrack3DrcSlider;
6767                 }
6768                 if( i == 4 )
6769                 {
6770                     trackLangPreviousPopUp = fAudLang3PopUp;
6771                     trackLangPopUp = fAudLang4PopUp;
6772                     mixdownPopUp = fAudTrack4MixPopUp;
6773                     audiocodecPopUp = fAudTrack4CodecPopUp;
6774                     sampleratePopUp = fAudTrack4RatePopUp;
6775                     bitratePopUp = fAudTrack4BitratePopUp;
6776                     drcSlider = fAudTrack4DrcSlider;
6777                 }
6778                 
6779                 
6780                 if ([trackLangPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
6781                 {
6782                     if (i ==1)
6783                     {
6784                         [trackLangPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 1];
6785                     }
6786                     else
6787                     {
6788                         /* if we are greater than track 1, select
6789                          * the same track as the previous track */
6790                         [trackLangPopUp selectItemAtIndex: [trackLangPreviousPopUp indexOfSelectedItem]];
6791                     }
6792                 }
6793                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: trackLangPopUp];
6794                 [audiocodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"]];
6795                 /* check our pref for core audio and use it in place of faac if preset is a built in  */
6796                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0 && 
6797                     [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"UseCoreAudio"] == YES && 
6798                     [[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString: @"AAC (faac)"])
6799                 {
6800                     [audiocodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)"];
6801                 }                    
6802                 
6803                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: audiocodecPopUp];
6804                 [mixdownPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioMixdown"]];
6805                 [self audioTrackMixdownChanged: mixdownPopUp];
6806                 /* check to see if the selection was available, if not, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged using the codec to just set the default
6807                  * mixdown*/
6808                 if  ([mixdownPopUp selectedItem] == nil)
6809                 {
6810                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: audiocodecPopUp];
6811                     [self writeToActivityLog: "presetSelected mixdown not selected, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged"];
6812                 }
6813                 [sampleratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioSamplerate"]];
6814                 /* We set the presets bitrate if it is *not* an AC3 track since that uses the input bitrate */
6815                 if (![[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"])
6816                 {
6817                     [bitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioBitrate"]];
6818                     /* check to see if the bitrate selection was available, if not, rerun audioTrackMixdownChanged using the mixdown to just set the
6819                      *default mixdown bitrate*/
6820                     if ([bitratePopUp selectedItem] == nil)
6821                     {
6822                         [self audioTrackMixdownChanged: mixdownPopUp];
6823                     }
6824                 }
6825                 [drcSlider setFloatValue:[[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioTrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
6826                 [self audioDRCSliderChanged: drcSlider];
6827                 
6828                 
6829                 /* If we are any track greater than 1 check to make sure we have a matching source codec is using ac3 passthru or dts passthru,
6830                  * if not we will set the track to "None". Track 1 is allowed to mixdown to a suitable DPL2 mix if we cannot passthru */
6831                 
6832                 if( i > 1 )
6833                 {
6834                     /* Check to see if the preset asks for a passhthru track (AC3 or DTS) and verify there is a matching source track if not, set the track to "None". */
6835                     if (([[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"] || [[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"DTS Passthru"])  && [trackLangPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] != 0)
6836                     {
6837                         hb_audio_config_t * audio;
6838                         /* get the audio source audio codec */
6839                         audio = (hb_audio_config_t *) hb_list_audio_config_item( fTitle->list_audio, [trackLangPopUp indexOfSelectedItem] - 1 );
6840                         if (audio != NULL && [[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"] && audio->in.codec != HB_ACODEC_AC3 ||
6841                             [[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"DTS Passthru"] && audio->in.codec != HB_ACODEC_DCA )
6842                         {
6843                             /* We have a preset using ac3 passthru but no ac3 source audio, so set the track to "None" and bail */
6844                             if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"])
6845                             {
6846                                 [self writeToActivityLog: "Preset calls for AC3 Pass thru ..."];
6847                             }
6848                             if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"AudioEncoder"] isEqualToString:@"DTS Passthru"])
6849                             {
6850                                 [self writeToActivityLog: "Preset calls for DTS Pass thru ..."];
6851                             }
6852                             [self writeToActivityLog: "No matching source codec, setting track  %d to None", i];
6853                             [trackLangPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
6854                             [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: trackLangPopUp]; 
6855                         }   
6856                     }
6857                 }
6858             }
6859             
6860             /* We now cleanup any extra audio tracks that may have been previously set if we need to */
6861             
6862             if (i < 4)
6863             {
6864                 [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
6865                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
6866                 
6867                 if (i < 3)
6868                 {
6869                     [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
6870                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
6871                     
6872                     if (i < 2)
6873                     {
6874                         [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
6875                         [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
6876                     }
6877                 }
6878             }
6879             
6880         }
6881         else
6882         {
6883             if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Track"] > 0)
6884             {
6885                 if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
6886                 {
6887                     [fAudLang1PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 1];
6888                 }
6889                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang1PopUp];
6890                 [fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Encoder"]];
6891                 /* check our pref for core audio and use it in place of faac if preset is built in */
6892                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0 && 
6893                     [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"UseCoreAudio"] == YES && 
6894                     [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Encoder"] isEqualToString: @"AAC (faac)"])
6895                 {
6896                     [fAudTrack1CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)"];
6897                 }
6898                 
6899                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack1CodecPopUp];
6900                 [fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Mixdown"]];
6901                 /* check to see if the selections was available, if not, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged using the codec to just set the default
6902                  * mixdown*/
6903                 if  ([fAudTrack1MixPopUp selectedItem] == nil)
6904                 {
6905                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack1CodecPopUp];
6906                 }
6907                 [fAudTrack1RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Samplerate"]];
6908                 /* We set the presets bitrate if it is *not* an AC3 track since that uses the input bitrate */
6909                 if (![[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Encoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"])
6910                 {
6911                     [fAudTrack1BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1Bitrate"]];
6912                 }
6913                 [fAudTrack1DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio1TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
6914                 [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack1DrcSlider];
6915             }
6916             
6917             if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] > 0)
6918             {
6919                 if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
6920                 {
6921                     [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 1];
6922                 }
6923                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
6924                 [fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Encoder"]];
6925                 /* check our pref for core audio and use it in place of faac if preset is built in */
6926                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0 && 
6927                     [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"UseCoreAudio"] == YES && 
6928                     [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Encoder"] isEqualToString: @"AAC (faac)"])
6929                 {
6930                     [fAudTrack2CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)"];
6931                 }
6932                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack2CodecPopUp];
6933                 [fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Mixdown"]];
6934                 /* check to see if the selections was available, if not, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged using the codec to just set the default
6935                  * mixdown*/
6936                 if  ([fAudTrack2MixPopUp selectedItem] == nil)
6937                 {
6938                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack2CodecPopUp];
6939                 }
6940                 [fAudTrack2RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Samplerate"]];
6941                 /* We set the presets bitrate if it is *not* an AC3 track since that uses the input bitrate */
6942                 if (![[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Encoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"])
6943                 {
6944                     [fAudTrack2BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Bitrate"]];
6945                 }
6946                 [fAudTrack2DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
6947                 [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack2DrcSlider];
6948             }
6949             if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] > 0)
6950             {
6951                 if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
6952                 {
6953                     [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 1];
6954                 }
6955                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
6956                 [fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Encoder"]];
6957                 /* check our pref for core audio and use it in place of faac if preset is built in */
6958                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0 && 
6959                     [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"UseCoreAudio"] == YES && 
6960                     [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Encoder"] isEqualToString: @"AAC (faac)"])
6961                 {
6962                     [fAudTrack3CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)"];
6963                 }
6964                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack3CodecPopUp];
6965                 [fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Mixdown"]];
6966                 /* check to see if the selections was available, if not, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged using the codec to just set the default
6967                  * mixdown*/
6968                 if  ([fAudTrack3MixPopUp selectedItem] == nil)
6969                 {
6970                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack3CodecPopUp];
6971                 }
6972                 [fAudTrack3RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Samplerate"]];
6973                 /* We set the presets bitrate if it is *not* an AC3 track since that uses the input bitrate */
6974                 if (![[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Encoder"] isEqualToString: @"AC3 Passthru"])
6975                 {
6976                     [fAudTrack3BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Bitrate"]];
6977                 }
6978                 [fAudTrack3DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
6979                 [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack3DrcSlider];
6980             }
6981             if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] > 0)
6982             {
6983                 if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0)
6984                 {
6985                     [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 1];
6986                 }
6987                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
6988                 [fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Encoder"]];
6989                 /* check our pref for core audio and use it in place of faac if preset is built in */
6990                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0 && 
6991                     [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey: @"UseCoreAudio"] == YES && 
6992                     [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Encoder"] isEqualToString: @"AAC (faac)"])
6993                 {
6994                     [fAudTrack4CodecPopUp selectItemWithTitle:@"AAC (CoreAudio)"];
6995                 }
6996                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack4CodecPopUp];
6997                 [fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Mixdown"]];
6998                 /* check to see if the selections was available, if not, rerun audioTrackPopUpChanged using the codec to just set the default
6999                  * mixdown*/
7000                 if  ([fAudTrack4MixPopUp selectedItem] == nil)
7001                 {
7002                     [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudTrack4CodecPopUp];
7003                 }
7004                 [fAudTrack4RatePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Samplerate"]];
7005                 /* We set the presets bitrate if it is *not* an AC3 track since that uses the input bitrate */
7006                 if (![[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Encoder"] isEqualToString:@"AC3 Passthru"])
7007                 {
7008                     [fAudTrack4BitratePopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Bitrate"]];
7009                 }
7010                 [fAudTrack4DrcSlider setFloatValue:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4TrackDRCSlider"] floatValue]];
7011                 [self audioDRCSliderChanged: fAudTrack4DrcSlider];
7012             }
7013             
7014             /* We now cleanup any extra audio tracks that may have been previously set if we need to */
7015             
7016             if (![chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] || [chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio2Track"] == 0)
7017             {
7018                 [fAudLang2PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
7019                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang2PopUp];
7020             }
7021             if (![chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] || [chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio3Track"] > 0)
7022             {
7023                 [fAudLang3PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
7024                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang3PopUp];
7025             }
7026             if (![chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] || [chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Audio4Track"] > 0)
7027             {
7028                 [fAudLang4PopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];
7029                 [self audioTrackPopUpChanged: fAudLang4PopUp];
7030             }
7031         }
7032         
7033         /*Subtitles*/
7034         [fSubPopUp selectItemWithTitle:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"Subtitles"]];
7035         /* Forced Subtitles */
7036         [fSubForcedCheck setState:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"SubtitlesForced"] intValue]];
7037         
7038         /* Picture Settings */
7039         /* Note: objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings" refers to picture size, which encompasses:
7040          * height, width, keep ar, anamorphic and crop settings.
7041          * picture filters are handled separately below.
7042          */
7043         /* Check to see if the objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings is greater than 0, as 0 means use picture sizing "None" 
7044          * ( 2 is use max for source and 1 is use exact size when the preset was created ) and the 
7045          * preset completely ignores any picture sizing values in the preset.
7046          */
7047         if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings"]  intValue] > 0)
7048         {
7049             hb_job_t * job = fTitle->job;
7050             
7051             /* If Cropping is set to custom, then recall all four crop values from
7052              when the preset was created and apply them */
7053             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureAutoCrop"]  intValue] == 0)
7054             {
7055                 [fPictureController setAutoCrop:NO];
7056                 
7057                 /* Here we use the custom crop values saved at the time the preset was saved */
7058                 job->crop[0] = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureTopCrop"]  intValue];
7059                 job->crop[1] = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"]  intValue];
7060                 job->crop[2] = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"]  intValue];
7061                 job->crop[3] = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureRightCrop"]  intValue];
7062                 
7063             }
7064             else /* if auto crop has been saved in preset, set to auto and use post scan auto crop */
7065             {
7066                 [fPictureController setAutoCrop:YES];
7067                 /* Here we use the auto crop values determined right after scan */
7068                 job->crop[0] = AutoCropTop;
7069                 job->crop[1] = AutoCropBottom;
7070                 job->crop[2] = AutoCropLeft;
7071                 job->crop[3] = AutoCropRight;
7072                 
7073             }
7074             
7075             /* Set modulus */
7076             if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureModulus"])
7077             {
7078                 job->modulus = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureModulus"]  intValue];
7079             }
7080             else
7081             {
7082                 job->modulus = 16;
7083             }
7084              
7085             /* Check to see if the objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings is 2 which is "Use Max for the source */
7086             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings"]  intValue] == 2 || [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"UsesMaxPictureSettings"]  intValue] == 1)
7087             {
7088                 /* Use Max Picture settings for whatever the dvd is.*/
7089                 [self revertPictureSizeToMax:nil];
7090                 job->keep_ratio = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"]  intValue];
7091                 if (job->keep_ratio == 1)
7092                 {
7093                     hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_WIDTH );
7094                     if( job->height > fTitle->height )
7095                     {
7096                         job->height = fTitle->height;
7097                         hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_HEIGHT );
7098                     }
7099                 }
7100                 job->anamorphic.mode = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PicturePAR"]  intValue];
7101             }
7102             else // /* If not 0 or 2 we assume objectForKey:@"UsesPictureSettings is 1 which is "Use picture sizing from when the preset was set" */
7103             {
7104                 /* we check to make sure the presets width/height does not exceed the sources width/height */
7105                 if (fTitle->width < [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureWidth"]  intValue] || fTitle->height < [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureHeight"]  intValue])
7106                 {
7107                     /* if so, then we use the sources height and width to avoid scaling up */
7108                     //job->width = fTitle->width;
7109                     //job->height = fTitle->height;
7110                     [self revertPictureSizeToMax:nil];
7111                 }
7112                 else // source width/height is >= the preset height/width
7113                 {
7114                     /* we can go ahead and use the presets values for height and width */
7115                     job->width = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureWidth"]  intValue];
7116                     job->height = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureHeight"]  intValue];
7117                 }
7118                 job->keep_ratio = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"]  intValue];
7119                 if (job->keep_ratio == 1)
7120                 {
7121                     hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_WIDTH );
7122                     if( job->height > fTitle->height )
7123                     {
7124                         job->height = fTitle->height;
7125                         hb_fix_aspect( job, HB_KEEP_HEIGHT );
7126                     }
7127                 }
7128                 job->anamorphic.mode = [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PicturePAR"]  intValue];
7129                 
7130             }
7131             
7132             
7133         }
7134         /* If the preset has an objectForKey:@"UsesPictureFilters", and handle the filters here */
7135         if ([chosenPreset objectForKey:@"UsesPictureFilters"] && [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"UsesPictureFilters"]  intValue] > 0)
7136         {
7137             /* Filters */
7138             
7139             /* We only allow *either* Decomb or Deinterlace. So check for the PictureDecombDeinterlace key.
7140              * also, older presets may not have this key, in which case we also check to see if that preset had  PictureDecomb
7141              * specified, in which case we use decomb and ignore any possible Deinterlace settings as using both was less than
7142              * sane.
7143              */
7144             [fPictureController setUseDecomb:1];
7145             [fPictureController setDecomb:0];
7146             [fPictureController setDeinterlace:0];
7147             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecombDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1 || [[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] > 0)
7148             {
7149                 /* we are using decomb */
7150                 /* Decomb */
7151                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] > 0)
7152                 {
7153                     [fPictureController setDecomb:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue]];
7154                     
7155                     /* if we are using "Custom" in the decomb setting, also set the custom string*/
7156                     if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecomb"] intValue] == 1)
7157                     {
7158                         [fPictureController setDecombCustomString:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDecombCustom"]];    
7159                     }
7160                 }
7161              }
7162             else
7163             {
7164                 /* We are using Deinterlace */
7165                 /* Deinterlace */
7166                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] > 0)
7167                 {
7168                     [fPictureController setUseDecomb:0];
7169                     [fPictureController setDeinterlace:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue]];
7170                     /* if we are using "Custom" in the deinterlace setting, also set the custom string*/
7171                     if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"] intValue] == 1)
7172                     {
7173                         [fPictureController setDeinterlaceCustomString:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeinterlaceCustom"]];    
7174                     }
7175                 }
7176             }
7177             
7178             
7179             /* Detelecine */
7180             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] > 0)
7181             {
7182                 [fPictureController setDetelecine:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue]];
7183                 /* if we are using "Custom" in the detelecine setting, also set the custom string*/
7184                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecine"] intValue] == 1)
7185                 {
7186                     [fPictureController setDetelecineCustomString:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDetelecineCustom"]];    
7187                 }
7188             }
7189             else
7190             {
7191                 [fPictureController setDetelecine:0];
7192             }
7193             
7194             /* Denoise */
7195             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] > 0)
7196             {
7197                 [fPictureController setDenoise:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue]];
7198                 /* if we are using "Custom" in the denoise setting, also set the custom string*/
7199                 if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDenoise"] intValue] == 1)
7200                 {
7201                     [fPictureController setDenoiseCustomString:[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDenoiseCustom"]];    
7202                 }
7203             }
7204             else
7205             {
7206                 [fPictureController setDenoise:0];
7207             }   
7208             
7209             /* Deblock */
7210             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] intValue] == 1)
7211             {
7212                 /* if its a one, then its the old on/off deblock, set on to 5*/
7213                 [fPictureController setDeblock:5];
7214             }
7215             else
7216             {
7217                 /* use the settings intValue */
7218                 [fPictureController setDeblock:[[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"PictureDeblock"] intValue]];
7219             }
7220             
7221             if ([[chosenPreset objectForKey:@"VideoGrayScale"] intValue] == 1)
7222             {
7223                 [fPictureController setGrayscale:1];
7224             }
7225             else
7226             {
7227                 [fPictureController setGrayscale:0];
7228             }
7229         }
7230         /* we call SetTitle: in fPictureController so we get an instant update in the Picture Settings window */
7231         [fPictureController SetTitle:fTitle];
7232         [fPictureController SetTitle:fTitle];
7233         [self calculatePictureSizing:nil];
7234     }
7235 }
7236
7237
7238 #pragma mark -
7239 #pragma mark Manage Presets
7240
7241 - (void) loadPresets {
7242         /* We declare the default NSFileManager into fileManager */
7243         NSFileManager * fileManager = [NSFileManager defaultManager];
7244         /*We define the location of the user presets file */
7245     UserPresetsFile = @"~/Library/Application Support/HandBrake/UserPresets.plist";
7246         UserPresetsFile = [[UserPresetsFile stringByExpandingTildeInPath]retain];
7247     /* We check for the presets.plist */
7248         if ([fileManager fileExistsAtPath:UserPresetsFile] == 0)
7249         {
7250                 [fileManager createFileAtPath:UserPresetsFile contents:nil attributes:nil];
7251         }
7252
7253         UserPresets = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:UserPresetsFile];
7254         if (nil == UserPresets)
7255         {
7256                 UserPresets = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
7257                 [self addFactoryPresets:nil];
7258         }
7259         [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7260     
7261     [self checkBuiltInsForUpdates];
7262 }
7263
7264 - (void) checkBuiltInsForUpdates {
7265     
7266         BOOL updateBuiltInPresets = NO;
7267     int i = 0;
7268     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [UserPresets objectEnumerator];
7269     id tempObject;
7270     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7271     {
7272         /* iterate through the built in presets to see if any have an old build number */
7273         NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7274         /*Key Type == 0 is built in, and key PresetBuildNumber is the build number it was created with */
7275         if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0)              
7276         {
7277                         if (![thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"PresetBuildNumber"] || [[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"PresetBuildNumber"] intValue] < [[[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleVersion"] intValue])
7278             {
7279                 updateBuiltInPresets = YES;
7280             }   
7281                 }
7282         i++;
7283     }
7284     /* if we have built in presets to update, then do so AlertBuiltInPresetUpdate*/
7285     if ( updateBuiltInPresets == YES)
7286     {
7287         if( [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] boolForKey:@"AlertBuiltInPresetUpdate"] == YES)
7288         {
7289             /* Show an alert window that built in presets will be updated */
7290             /*On Screen Notification*/
7291             int status;
7292             NSBeep();
7293             status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"HandBrake has determined your built in presets are out of date...",@"HandBrake will now update your built-in presets.", @"OK", nil, nil);
7294             [NSApp requestUserAttention:NSCriticalRequest];
7295         }
7296         /* when alert is dismissed, go ahead and update the built in presets */
7297         [self addFactoryPresets:nil];
7298     }
7299     
7300 }
7301
7302
7303 - (IBAction) showAddPresetPanel: (id) sender
7304 {
7305     /* Deselect the currently selected Preset if there is one*/
7306     [fPresetsOutlineView deselectRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
7307
7308     /* Populate the preset picture settings popup here */
7309     [fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp removeAllItems];
7310     [fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp addItemWithTitle:@"None"];
7311     [fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp addItemWithTitle:@"Current"];
7312     [fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp addItemWithTitle:@"Source Maximum (post source scan)"];
7313     [fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp selectItemAtIndex: 0];  
7314     /* Uncheck the preset use filters checkbox */
7315     [fPresetNewPicFiltersCheck setState:NSOffState];
7316     // fPresetNewFolderCheck
7317     [fPresetNewFolderCheck setState:NSOffState];
7318     /* Erase info from the input fields*/
7319         [fPresetNewName setStringValue: @""];
7320         [fPresetNewDesc setStringValue: @""];
7321         /* Show the panel */
7322         [NSApp beginSheet:fAddPresetPanel modalForWindow:fWindow modalDelegate:nil didEndSelector:NULL contextInfo:NULL];
7323 }
7324
7325 - (IBAction) closeAddPresetPanel: (id) sender
7326 {
7327     [NSApp endSheet: fAddPresetPanel];
7328     [fAddPresetPanel orderOut: self];
7329 }
7330
7331 - (IBAction)addUserPreset:(id)sender
7332 {
7333     if (![[fPresetNewName stringValue] length])
7334             NSRunAlertPanel(@"Warning!", @"You need to insert a name for the preset.", @"OK", nil , nil);
7335     else
7336     {
7337         /* Here we create a custom user preset */
7338         [UserPresets addObject:[self createPreset]];
7339         [self addPreset];
7340
7341         [self closeAddPresetPanel:nil];
7342     }
7343 }
7344 - (void)addPreset
7345 {
7346
7347         
7348         /* We Reload the New Table data for presets */
7349     [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7350    /* We save all of the preset data here */
7351     [self savePreset];
7352 }
7353
7354 - (void)sortPresets
7355 {
7356
7357         
7358         /* We Sort the Presets By Factory or Custom */
7359         NSSortDescriptor * presetTypeDescriptor=[[[NSSortDescriptor alloc] initWithKey:@"Type" 
7360                                                     ascending:YES] autorelease];
7361         /* We Sort the Presets Alphabetically by name  We do not use this now as we have drag and drop*/
7362         /*
7363     NSSortDescriptor * presetNameDescriptor=[[[NSSortDescriptor alloc] initWithKey:@"PresetName" 
7364                                                     ascending:YES selector:@selector(caseInsensitiveCompare:)] autorelease];
7365         //NSArray *sortDescriptors=[NSArray arrayWithObjects:presetTypeDescriptor,presetNameDescriptor,nil];
7366     
7367     */
7368     /* Since we can drag and drop our custom presets, lets just sort by type and not name */
7369     NSArray *sortDescriptors=[NSArray arrayWithObjects:presetTypeDescriptor,nil];
7370         NSArray *sortedArray=[UserPresets sortedArrayUsingDescriptors:sortDescriptors];
7371         [UserPresets setArray:sortedArray];
7372         
7373
7374 }
7375
7376 - (IBAction)insertPreset:(id)sender
7377 {
7378     int index = [fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow];
7379     [UserPresets insertObject:[self createPreset] atIndex:index];
7380     [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7381     [self savePreset];
7382 }
7383
7384 - (NSDictionary *)createPreset
7385 {
7386     NSMutableDictionary *preset = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
7387     /* Preset build number */
7388     [preset setObject:[NSString stringWithFormat: @"%d", [[[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleVersion"] intValue]] forKey:@"PresetBuildNumber"];
7389     [preset setObject:[fPresetNewName stringValue] forKey:@"PresetName"];
7390         /* Get the New Preset Name from the field in the AddPresetPanel */
7391     [preset setObject:[fPresetNewName stringValue] forKey:@"PresetName"];
7392     /* Set whether or not this is to be a folder fPresetNewFolderCheck*/
7393     [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithBool:[fPresetNewFolderCheck state]] forKey:@"Folder"];
7394         /*Set whether or not this is a user preset or factory 0 is factory, 1 is user*/
7395         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:1] forKey:@"Type"];
7396         /*Set whether or not this is default, at creation set to 0*/
7397         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Default"];
7398     if ([fPresetNewFolderCheck state] == YES)
7399     {
7400         /* initialize and set an empty array for children here since we are a new folder */
7401         NSMutableArray *childrenArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
7402         [preset setObject:[NSMutableArray arrayWithArray: childrenArray] forKey:@"ChildrenArray"];
7403         [childrenArray autorelease];
7404     }
7405     else // we are not creating a preset folder, so we go ahead with the rest of the preset info
7406     {
7407         /*Get the whether or not to apply pic Size and Cropping (includes Anamorphic)*/
7408         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPresetNewPicSettingsPopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"UsesPictureSettings"];
7409         /* Get whether or not to use the current Picture Filter settings for the preset */
7410         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPresetNewPicFiltersCheck state]] forKey:@"UsesPictureFilters"];
7411         
7412         /* Get New Preset Description from the field in the AddPresetPanel*/
7413         [preset setObject:[fPresetNewDesc stringValue] forKey:@"PresetDescription"];
7414         /* File Format */
7415         [preset setObject:[fDstFormatPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"FileFormat"];
7416         /* Chapter Markers fCreateChapterMarkers*/
7417         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fCreateChapterMarkers state]] forKey:@"ChapterMarkers"];
7418         /* Allow Mpeg4 64 bit formatting +4GB file sizes */
7419         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4LargeFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4LargeFile"];
7420         /* Mux mp4 with http optimization */
7421         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4HttpOptFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4HttpOptimize"];
7422         /* Add iPod uuid atom */
7423         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fDstMp4iPodFileCheck state]] forKey:@"Mp4iPodCompatible"];
7424         
7425         /* Codecs */
7426         /* Video encoder */
7427         [preset setObject:[fVidEncoderPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"VideoEncoder"];
7428         /* x264 Option String */
7429         [preset setObject:[fAdvancedOptions optionsString] forKey:@"x264Option"];
7430         
7431         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidQualityMatrix selectedRow]] forKey:@"VideoQualityType"];
7432         [preset setObject:[fVidTargetSizeField stringValue] forKey:@"VideoTargetSize"];
7433         [preset setObject:[fVidBitrateField stringValue] forKey:@"VideoAvgBitrate"];
7434         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fVidQualityRFField floatValue]] forKey:@"VideoQualitySlider"];
7435         
7436         /* Video framerate */
7437         if ([fVidRatePopUp indexOfSelectedItem] == 0) // Same as source is selected
7438         {
7439             [preset setObject:@"Same as source" forKey:@"VideoFramerate"];
7440         }
7441         else // we can record the actual titleOfSelectedItem
7442         {
7443             [preset setObject:[fVidRatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"VideoFramerate"];
7444         }
7445         
7446         /* 2 Pass Encoding */
7447         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidTwoPassCheck state]] forKey:@"VideoTwoPass"];
7448         /* Turbo 2 pass Encoding fVidTurboPassCheck*/
7449         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fVidTurboPassCheck state]] forKey:@"VideoTurboTwoPass"];
7450         /*Picture Settings*/
7451         hb_job_t * job = fTitle->job;
7452         /* Picture Sizing */
7453         /* Use Max Picture settings for whatever the dvd is.*/
7454         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"UsesMaxPictureSettings"];
7455         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->width] forKey:@"PictureWidth"];
7456         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->height] forKey:@"PictureHeight"];
7457         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->keep_ratio] forKey:@"PictureKeepRatio"];
7458         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->anamorphic.mode] forKey:@"PicturePAR"];
7459         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:fTitle->job->modulus] forKey:@"PictureModulus"];
7460         
7461         /* Set crop settings here */
7462         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController autoCrop]] forKey:@"PictureAutoCrop"];
7463         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[0]] forKey:@"PictureTopCrop"];
7464         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[1]] forKey:@"PictureBottomCrop"];
7465         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[2]] forKey:@"PictureLeftCrop"];
7466         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:job->crop[3]] forKey:@"PictureRightCrop"];
7467         
7468         /* Picture Filters */
7469         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController useDecomb]] forKey:@"PictureDecombDeinterlace"];
7470         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController deinterlace]] forKey:@"PictureDeinterlace"];
7471         [preset setObject:[fPictureController deinterlaceCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDeinterlaceCustom"];
7472         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController detelecine]] forKey:@"PictureDetelecine"];
7473         [preset setObject:[fPictureController detelecineCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDetelecineCustom"];
7474         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController denoise]] forKey:@"PictureDenoise"];
7475         [preset setObject:[fPictureController denoiseCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDenoiseCustom"];
7476         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController deblock]] forKey:@"PictureDeblock"]; 
7477         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController decomb]] forKey:@"PictureDecomb"];
7478         [preset setObject:[fPictureController decombCustomString] forKey:@"PictureDecombCustom"];
7479         [preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fPictureController grayscale]] forKey:@"VideoGrayScale"];
7480         
7481         /*Audio*/
7482         NSMutableArray *audioListArray = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
7483         /* we actually call the methods for the nests here */
7484         if ([fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
7485         {
7486             NSMutableDictionary *audioTrack1Array = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
7487             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang1PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"AudioTrack"];
7488             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[fAudLang1PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioTrackDescription"];
7489             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[fAudTrack1CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioEncoder"];
7490             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[fAudTrack1MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioMixdown"];
7491             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[fAudTrack1RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioSamplerate"];
7492             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[fAudTrack1BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioBitrate"];
7493             [audioTrack1Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack1DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"AudioTrackDRCSlider"];
7494             [audioTrack1Array autorelease];
7495             [audioListArray addObject:audioTrack1Array];
7496         }
7497         
7498         if ([fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
7499         {
7500             NSMutableDictionary *audioTrack2Array = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
7501             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang2PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"AudioTrack"];
7502             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[fAudLang2PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioTrackDescription"];
7503             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[fAudTrack2CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioEncoder"];
7504             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[fAudTrack2MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioMixdown"];
7505             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[fAudTrack2RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioSamplerate"];
7506             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[fAudTrack2BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioBitrate"];
7507             [audioTrack2Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack2DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"AudioTrackDRCSlider"];
7508             [audioTrack2Array autorelease];
7509             [audioListArray addObject:audioTrack2Array];
7510         }
7511         
7512         if ([fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
7513         {
7514             NSMutableDictionary *audioTrack3Array = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
7515             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang3PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"AudioTrack"];
7516             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[fAudLang3PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioTrackDescription"];
7517             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[fAudTrack3CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioEncoder"];
7518             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[fAudTrack3MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioMixdown"];
7519             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[fAudTrack3RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioSamplerate"];
7520             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[fAudTrack3BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioBitrate"];
7521             [audioTrack3Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack3DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"AudioTrackDRCSlider"];
7522             [audioTrack3Array autorelease];
7523             [audioListArray addObject:audioTrack3Array];
7524         }
7525         
7526         if ([fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem] > 0)
7527         {
7528             NSMutableDictionary *audioTrack4Array = [[NSMutableDictionary alloc] init];
7529             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fAudLang4PopUp indexOfSelectedItem]] forKey:@"AudioTrack"];
7530             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[fAudLang4PopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioTrackDescription"];
7531             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[fAudTrack4CodecPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioEncoder"];
7532             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[fAudTrack4MixPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioMixdown"];
7533             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[fAudTrack4RatePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioSamplerate"];
7534             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[fAudTrack4BitratePopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"AudioBitrate"];
7535             [audioTrack4Array setObject:[NSNumber numberWithFloat:[fAudTrack4DrcSlider floatValue]] forKey:@"AudioTrackDRCSlider"];
7536             [audioTrack4Array autorelease];
7537             [audioListArray addObject:audioTrack4Array];
7538         }
7539         
7540         
7541         [preset setObject:[NSMutableArray arrayWithArray: audioListArray] forKey:@"AudioList"];
7542
7543         
7544         /* Temporarily remove subtitles from creating a new preset as it has to be converted over to use the new
7545          * subititle array code. */
7546         /* Subtitles*/
7547         //[preset setObject:[fSubPopUp titleOfSelectedItem] forKey:@"Subtitles"];
7548         /* Forced Subtitles */
7549         //[preset setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[fSubForcedCheck state]] forKey:@"SubtitlesForced"];
7550     }
7551     [preset autorelease];
7552     return preset;
7553     
7554 }
7555
7556 - (void)savePreset
7557 {
7558     [UserPresets writeToFile:UserPresetsFile atomically:YES];
7559         /* We get the default preset in case it changed */
7560         [self getDefaultPresets:nil];
7561
7562 }
7563
7564 - (IBAction)deletePreset:(id)sender
7565 {
7566     
7567     
7568     if ( [fPresetsOutlineView numberOfSelectedRows] == 0 )
7569     {
7570         return;
7571     }
7572     /* Alert user before deleting preset */
7573         int status;
7574     status = NSRunAlertPanel(@"Warning!", @"Are you sure that you want to delete the selected preset?", @"OK", @"Cancel", nil);
7575     
7576     if ( status == NSAlertDefaultReturn ) 
7577     {
7578         int presetToModLevel = [fPresetsOutlineView levelForItem: [fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]]];
7579         NSDictionary *presetToMod = [fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
7580         NSDictionary *presetToModParent = [fPresetsOutlineView parentForItem: presetToMod];
7581         
7582         NSEnumerator *enumerator;
7583         NSMutableArray *presetsArrayToMod;
7584         NSMutableArray *tempArray;
7585         id tempObject;
7586         /* If we are a root level preset, we are modding the UserPresets array */
7587         if (presetToModLevel == 0)
7588         {
7589             presetsArrayToMod = UserPresets;
7590         }
7591         else // We have a parent preset, so we modify the chidren array object for key
7592         {
7593             presetsArrayToMod = [presetToModParent objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"]; 
7594         }
7595         
7596         enumerator = [presetsArrayToMod objectEnumerator];
7597         tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
7598         
7599         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject]) 
7600         {
7601             NSDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7602             if (thisPresetDict == presetToMod)
7603             {
7604                 [tempArray addObject:tempObject];
7605             }
7606         }
7607         
7608         [presetsArrayToMod removeObjectsInArray:tempArray];
7609         [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7610         [self savePreset];   
7611     }
7612 }
7613
7614
7615 #pragma mark -
7616 #pragma mark Import Export Preset(s)
7617
7618 - (IBAction) browseExportPresetFile: (id) sender
7619 {
7620     /* Open a panel to let the user choose where and how to save the export file */
7621     NSSavePanel * panel = [NSSavePanel savePanel];
7622         /* We get the current file name and path from the destination field here */
7623     NSString *defaultExportDirectory = [NSString stringWithFormat: @"%@/Desktop/", NSHomeDirectory()];
7624
7625         [panel beginSheetForDirectory: defaultExportDirectory file: @"HB_Export.plist"
7626                                    modalForWindow: fWindow modalDelegate: self
7627                                    didEndSelector: @selector( browseExportPresetFileDone:returnCode:contextInfo: )
7628                                           contextInfo: NULL];
7629 }
7630
7631 - (void) browseExportPresetFileDone: (NSSavePanel *) sheet
7632                    returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
7633 {
7634     if( returnCode == NSOKButton )
7635     {
7636         NSString *presetExportDirectory = [[sheet filename] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
7637         NSString *exportPresetsFile = [sheet filename];
7638         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:presetExportDirectory forKey:@"LastPresetExportDirectory"];
7639         /* We check for the presets.plist */
7640         if ([[NSFileManager defaultManager] fileExistsAtPath:exportPresetsFile] == 0)
7641         {
7642             [[NSFileManager defaultManager] createFileAtPath:exportPresetsFile contents:nil attributes:nil];
7643         }
7644         NSMutableArray * presetsToExport = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:exportPresetsFile];
7645         if (nil == presetsToExport)
7646         {
7647             presetsToExport = [[NSMutableArray alloc] init];
7648             
7649             /* now get and add selected presets to export */
7650             
7651         }
7652         if ([fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow] >= 0 && [[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] != 1)
7653         {
7654             [presetsToExport addObject:[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]]];
7655             [presetsToExport writeToFile:exportPresetsFile atomically:YES];
7656             
7657         }
7658         
7659     }
7660 }
7661
7662
7663 - (IBAction) browseImportPresetFile: (id) sender
7664 {
7665
7666     NSOpenPanel * panel;
7667         
7668     panel = [NSOpenPanel openPanel];
7669     [panel setAllowsMultipleSelection: NO];
7670     [panel setCanChooseFiles: YES];
7671     [panel setCanChooseDirectories: NO ];
7672     NSString * sourceDirectory;
7673         if ([[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastPresetImportDirectory"])
7674         {
7675                 sourceDirectory = [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] stringForKey:@"LastPresetImportDirectory"];
7676         }
7677         else
7678         {
7679                 sourceDirectory = @"~/Desktop";
7680                 sourceDirectory = [sourceDirectory stringByExpandingTildeInPath];
7681         }
7682     /* we open up the browse sources sheet here and call for browseSourcesDone after the sheet is closed
7683         * to evaluate whether we want to specify a title, we pass the sender in the contextInfo variable
7684         */
7685     /* set this for allowed file types, not sure if we should allow xml or not */
7686     NSArray *fileTypes = [NSArray arrayWithObjects:@"plist", @"xml", nil];
7687     [panel beginSheetForDirectory: sourceDirectory file: nil types: fileTypes
7688                    modalForWindow: fWindow modalDelegate: self
7689                    didEndSelector: @selector( browseImportPresetDone:returnCode:contextInfo: )
7690                       contextInfo: sender];
7691 }
7692
7693 - (void) browseImportPresetDone: (NSSavePanel *) sheet
7694                      returnCode: (int) returnCode contextInfo: (void *) contextInfo
7695 {
7696     if( returnCode == NSOKButton )
7697     {
7698         NSString *importPresetsDirectory = [[sheet filename] stringByDeletingLastPathComponent];
7699         NSString *importPresetsFile = [sheet filename];
7700         [[NSUserDefaults standardUserDefaults] setObject:importPresetsDirectory forKey:@"LastPresetImportDirectory"];
7701         /* NOTE: here we need to do some sanity checking to verify we do not hose up our presets file   */
7702         NSMutableArray * presetsToImport = [[NSMutableArray alloc] initWithContentsOfFile:importPresetsFile];
7703         /* iterate though the new array of presets to import and add them to our presets array */
7704         int i = 0;
7705         NSEnumerator *enumerator = [presetsToImport objectEnumerator];
7706         id tempObject;
7707         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7708         {
7709             /* make any changes to the incoming preset we see fit */
7710             /* make sure the incoming preset is not tagged as default */
7711             [tempObject setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Default"];
7712             /* prepend "(imported) to the name of the incoming preset for clarification since it can be changed */
7713             NSString * prependedName = [@"(import) " stringByAppendingString:[tempObject objectForKey:@"PresetName"]] ;
7714             [tempObject setObject:prependedName forKey:@"PresetName"];
7715             
7716             /* actually add the new preset to our presets array */
7717             [UserPresets addObject:tempObject];
7718             i++;
7719         }
7720         [presetsToImport autorelease];
7721         [self sortPresets];
7722         [self addPreset];
7723         
7724     }
7725 }
7726
7727 #pragma mark -
7728 #pragma mark Manage Default Preset
7729
7730 - (IBAction)getDefaultPresets:(id)sender
7731 {
7732         presetHbDefault = nil;
7733     presetUserDefault = nil;
7734     presetUserDefaultParent = nil;
7735     presetUserDefaultParentParent = nil;
7736     NSMutableDictionary *presetHbDefaultParent = nil;
7737     NSMutableDictionary *presetHbDefaultParentParent = nil;
7738     
7739     int i = 0;
7740     BOOL userDefaultFound = NO;
7741     presetCurrentBuiltInCount = 0;
7742     /* First we iterate through the root UserPresets array to check for defaults */
7743     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [UserPresets objectEnumerator];
7744         id tempObject;
7745         while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7746         {
7747                 NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7748                 if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 1) // 1 is HB default
7749                 {
7750                         presetHbDefault = thisPresetDict;       
7751                 }
7752                 if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 2) // 2 is User specified default
7753                 {
7754                         presetUserDefault = thisPresetDict;
7755             userDefaultFound = YES;
7756         }
7757         if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0) // Type 0 is a built in preset               
7758         {
7759                         presetCurrentBuiltInCount++; // <--increment the current number of built in presets     
7760                 }
7761                 i++;
7762         
7763         /* if we run into a folder, go to level 1 and iterate through the children arrays for the default */
7764         if ([thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
7765         {
7766             NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDictParent = thisPresetDict;
7767             NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectEnumerator];
7768             id tempObject;
7769             while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7770             {
7771                 NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7772                 if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 1) // 1 is HB default
7773                 {
7774                     presetHbDefault = thisPresetDict;
7775                     presetHbDefaultParent = thisPresetDictParent;
7776                 }
7777                 if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 2) // 2 is User specified default
7778                 {
7779                     presetUserDefault = thisPresetDict;
7780                     presetUserDefaultParent = thisPresetDictParent;
7781                     userDefaultFound = YES;
7782                 }
7783                 
7784                 /* if we run into a folder, go to level 2 and iterate through the children arrays for the default */
7785                 if ([thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
7786                 {
7787                     NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDictParentParent = thisPresetDict;
7788                     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectEnumerator];
7789                     id tempObject;
7790                     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7791                     {
7792                         NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7793                         if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 1) // 1 is HB default
7794                         {
7795                             presetHbDefault = thisPresetDict;
7796                             presetHbDefaultParent = thisPresetDictParent;
7797                             presetHbDefaultParentParent = thisPresetDictParentParent;   
7798                         }
7799                         if ([[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] == 2) // 2 is User specified default
7800                         {
7801                             presetUserDefault = thisPresetDict;
7802                             presetUserDefaultParent = thisPresetDictParent;
7803                             presetUserDefaultParentParent = thisPresetDictParentParent;
7804                             userDefaultFound = YES;     
7805                         }
7806                         
7807                     }
7808                 }
7809             }
7810         }
7811         
7812         }
7813     /* check to see if a user specified preset was found, if not then assign the parents for
7814      * the presetHbDefault so that we can open the parents for the nested presets
7815      */
7816     if (userDefaultFound == NO)
7817     {
7818         presetUserDefaultParent = presetHbDefaultParent;
7819         presetUserDefaultParentParent = presetHbDefaultParentParent;
7820     }
7821 }
7822
7823 - (IBAction)setDefaultPreset:(id)sender
7824 {
7825 /* We need to determine if the item is a folder */
7826    if ([[[fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]] objectForKey:@"Folder"] intValue] == 1)
7827    {
7828    return;
7829    }
7830
7831     int i = 0;
7832     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [UserPresets objectEnumerator];
7833         id tempObject;
7834         /* First make sure the old user specified default preset is removed */
7835     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7836         {
7837                 NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7838                 if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] != 1) // if not the default HB Preset, set to 0
7839                 {
7840                         [[UserPresets objectAtIndex:i] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Default"]; 
7841                 }
7842                 
7843                 /* if we run into a folder, go to level 1 and iterate through the children arrays for the default */
7844         if ([thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
7845         {
7846             NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectEnumerator];
7847             id tempObject;
7848             int ii = 0;
7849             while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7850             {
7851                 NSMutableDictionary *thisPresetDict1 = tempObject;
7852                 if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] != 1) // if not the default HB Preset, set to 0
7853                 {
7854                     [[[thisPresetDict objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectAtIndex:ii] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Default"]; 
7855                 }
7856                 /* if we run into a folder, go to level 2 and iterate through the children arrays for the default */
7857                 if ([thisPresetDict1 objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"])
7858                 {
7859                     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [[thisPresetDict1 objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectEnumerator];
7860                     id tempObject;
7861                     int iii = 0;
7862                     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
7863                     {
7864                         if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] != 1) // if not the default HB Preset, set to 0
7865                         {
7866                             [[[thisPresetDict1 objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"] objectAtIndex:iii] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:0] forKey:@"Default"];       
7867                         }
7868                         iii++;
7869                     }
7870                 }
7871                 ii++;
7872             }
7873             
7874         }
7875         i++; 
7876         }
7877     
7878     
7879     int presetToModLevel = [fPresetsOutlineView levelForItem: [fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]]];
7880     NSDictionary *presetToMod = [fPresetsOutlineView itemAtRow:[fPresetsOutlineView selectedRow]];
7881     NSDictionary *presetToModParent = [fPresetsOutlineView parentForItem: presetToMod];
7882     
7883     
7884     NSMutableArray *presetsArrayToMod;
7885     NSMutableArray *tempArray;
7886     
7887     /* If we are a root level preset, we are modding the UserPresets array */
7888     if (presetToModLevel == 0)
7889     {
7890         presetsArrayToMod = UserPresets;
7891     }
7892     else // We have a parent preset, so we modify the chidren array object for key
7893     {
7894         presetsArrayToMod = [presetToModParent objectForKey:@"ChildrenArray"]; 
7895     }
7896     
7897     enumerator = [presetsArrayToMod objectEnumerator];
7898     tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
7899     int iiii = 0;
7900     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject]) 
7901     {
7902         NSDictionary *thisPresetDict = tempObject;
7903         if (thisPresetDict == presetToMod)
7904         {
7905             if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Default"] intValue] != 1) // if not the default HB Preset, set to 2
7906             {
7907                 [[presetsArrayToMod objectAtIndex:iiii] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:2] forKey:@"Default"];        
7908             }
7909         }
7910      iiii++;
7911      }
7912     
7913     
7914     /* We save all of the preset data here */
7915     [self savePreset];
7916     /* We Reload the New Table data for presets */
7917     [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7918 }
7919
7920 - (IBAction)selectDefaultPreset:(id)sender
7921 {
7922         NSMutableDictionary *presetToMod;
7923     /* if there is a user specified default, we use it */
7924         if (presetUserDefault)
7925         {
7926         presetToMod = presetUserDefault;
7927     }
7928         else if (presetHbDefault) //else we use the built in default presetHbDefault
7929         {
7930         presetToMod = presetHbDefault;
7931         }
7932     else
7933     {
7934     return;
7935     }
7936     
7937     if (presetUserDefaultParent != nil)
7938     {
7939         [fPresetsOutlineView expandItem:presetUserDefaultParent];
7940         
7941     }
7942     if (presetUserDefaultParentParent != nil)
7943     {
7944         [fPresetsOutlineView expandItem:presetUserDefaultParentParent];
7945         
7946     }
7947     
7948     [fPresetsOutlineView selectRowIndexes:[NSIndexSet indexSetWithIndex:[fPresetsOutlineView rowForItem: presetToMod]] byExtendingSelection:NO];
7949         [self selectPreset:nil];
7950 }
7951
7952
7953 #pragma mark -
7954 #pragma mark Manage Built In Presets
7955
7956
7957 - (IBAction)deleteFactoryPresets:(id)sender
7958 {
7959     //int status;
7960     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [UserPresets objectEnumerator];
7961         id tempObject;
7962     
7963         //NSNumber *index;
7964     NSMutableArray *tempArray;
7965
7966
7967         tempArray = [NSMutableArray array];
7968         /* we look here to see if the preset is we move on to the next one */
7969         while ( tempObject = [enumerator nextObject] )  
7970                 {
7971                         /* if the preset is "Factory" then we put it in the array of
7972                         presets to delete */
7973                         if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0)
7974                         {
7975                                 [tempArray addObject:tempObject];
7976                         }
7977         }
7978         
7979         [UserPresets removeObjectsInArray:tempArray];
7980         [fPresetsOutlineView reloadData];
7981         [self savePreset];   
7982
7983 }
7984
7985    /* We use this method to recreate new, updated factory presets */
7986 - (IBAction)addFactoryPresets:(id)sender
7987 {
7988     
7989     /* First, we delete any existing built in presets */
7990     [self deleteFactoryPresets: sender];
7991     /* Then we generate new built in presets programmatically with fPresetsBuiltin
7992      * which is all setup in HBPresets.h and  HBPresets.m*/
7993     [fPresetsBuiltin generateBuiltinPresets:UserPresets];
7994     /* update build number for built in presets */
7995     /* iterate though the new array of presets to import and add them to our presets array */
7996     int i = 0;
7997     NSEnumerator *enumerator = [UserPresets objectEnumerator];
7998     id tempObject;
7999     while (tempObject = [enumerator nextObject])
8000     {
8001         /* Record the apps current build number in the PresetBuildNumber key */
8002         if ([[tempObject objectForKey:@"Type"] intValue] == 0) // Type 0 is a built in preset           
8003         {
8004             /* Preset build number */
8005             [[UserPresets objectAtIndex:i] setObject:[NSNumber numberWithInt:[[[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleVersion"] intValue]] forKey:@"PresetBuildNumber"];
8006         }
8007         i++;
8008     }
8009     /* report the built in preset updating to the activity log */
8010     [self writeToActivityLog: "built in presets updated to build number: %d", [[[[NSBundle mainBundle] infoDictionary] objectForKey:@"CFBundleVersion"] intValue]];
8011     
8012     [self sortPresets];
8013     [self addPreset];
8014     
8015 }
8016
8017
8018 @end
8019
8020 /*******************************
8021  * Subclass of the HBPresetsOutlineView *
8022  *******************************/
8023
8024 @implementation HBPresetsOutlineView
8025 - (NSImage *)dragImageForRowsWithIndexes:(NSIndexSet *)dragRows tableColumns:(NSArray *)tableColumns event:(NSEvent*)dragEvent offset:(NSPointPointer)dragImageOffset
8026 {
8027     fIsDragging = YES;
8028
8029     // By default, NSTableView only drags an image of the first column. Change this to
8030     // drag an image of the queue's icon and PresetName columns.
8031     NSArray * cols = [NSArray arrayWithObjects: [self tableColumnWithIdentifier:@"PresetName"], nil];
8032     return [super dragImageForRowsWithIndexes:dragRows tableColumns:cols event:dragEvent offset:dragImageOffset];
8033 }
8034
8035
8036
8037 - (void) mouseDown:(NSEvent *)theEvent
8038 {
8039     [super mouseDown:theEvent];
8040         fIsDragging = NO;
8041 }
8042
8043
8044
8045 - (BOOL) isDragging;
8046 {
8047     return fIsDragging;
8048 }
8049 @end
8050
8051
8052